Fix type of .persistent.bss section
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf.c
1 /* ELF executable support for BFD.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1993-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /*
24 SECTION
25 ELF backends
26
27 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
30
31 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 haven't bothered yet. */
34
35 /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
36 #define _SYSCALL32
37 #include "sysdep.h"
38 #include <limits.h>
39 #include "bfd.h"
40 #include "bfdlink.h"
41 #include "libbfd.h"
42 #define ARCH_SIZE 0
43 #include "elf-bfd.h"
44 #include "libiberty.h"
45 #include "safe-ctype.h"
46 #include "elf-linux-core.h"
47
48 #ifdef CORE_HEADER
49 #include CORE_HEADER
50 #endif
51
52 static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
53 static bool assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
54 static bool swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int,
55 struct bfd_link_info *);
56 static bool elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
57 file_ptr offset, size_t align);
58
59 /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
60 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
61 need to move into elfcode.h. */
62
63 /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
64
65 void
66 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
67 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
68 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
69 {
70 dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
71 dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
72 dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
73 dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
74 dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
75 dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
76 dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
77 }
78
79 /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
80
81 void
82 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
83 const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
84 Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
85 {
86 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
87 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
88 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
89 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
90 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
91 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
92 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
93 }
94
95 /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
96
97 void
98 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
99 const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
100 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
101 {
102 dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
103 dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
104 }
105
106 /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
107
108 void
109 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
110 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
111 Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
112 {
113 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
114 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
115 }
116
117 /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
118
119 void
120 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
121 const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
122 Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
123 {
124 dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
125 dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
126 dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
127 dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
128 dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
129 }
130
131 /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
132
133 void
134 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
135 const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
136 Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
137 {
138 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
139 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
140 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
141 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
142 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
143 }
144
145 /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
146
147 void
148 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
149 const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
150 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
151 {
152 dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
153 dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
154 dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
155 dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
156 dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
157 }
158
159 /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
160
161 void
162 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
163 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
164 Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
165 {
166 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
167 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
168 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
169 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
170 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
171 }
172
173 /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
174
175 void
176 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
177 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
178 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
179 {
180 dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
181 }
182
183 /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
184
185 void
186 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
187 const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
188 Elf_External_Versym *dst)
189 {
190 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
191 }
192
193 /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
194 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
195
196 unsigned long
197 bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
198 {
199 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
200 unsigned long h = 0;
201 unsigned long g;
202 int ch;
203
204 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
205 {
206 h = (h << 4) + ch;
207 if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
208 {
209 h ^= g >> 24;
210 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
211 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
212 h ^= g;
213 }
214 }
215 return h & 0xffffffff;
216 }
217
218 /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
219 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
220
221 unsigned long
222 bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
223 {
224 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
225 unsigned long h = 5381;
226 unsigned char ch;
227
228 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
229 h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
230 return h & 0xffffffff;
231 }
232
233 /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
234 the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
235 bool
236 bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
237 size_t object_size,
238 enum elf_target_id object_id)
239 {
240 BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
241 abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
242 if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
243 return false;
244
245 elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
246 if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
247 {
248 struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
249 if (o == NULL)
250 return false;
251 elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
252 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
253 }
254 return true;
255 }
256
257
258 bool
259 bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
260 {
261 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
262 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
263 bed->target_id);
264 }
265
266 bool
267 bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
268 {
269 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
270 if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
271 return false;
272 elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
273 return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
274 }
275
276 char *
277 bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
278 {
279 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
280 bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
281 file_ptr offset;
282 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
283
284 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
285 if (i_shdrp == 0
286 || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
287 || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
288 return NULL;
289
290 shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
291 if (shstrtab == NULL)
292 {
293 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
294 offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
295 shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
296
297 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
298 in case the string table is not terminated. */
299 if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
300 || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
301 || (shstrtab = _bfd_alloc_and_read (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1,
302 shstrtabsize)) == NULL)
303 {
304 /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
305 trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
306 the string table over and over. */
307 i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
308 }
309 else
310 shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
311 i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
312 }
313 return (char *) shstrtab;
314 }
315
316 char *
317 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
318 unsigned int shindex,
319 unsigned int strindex)
320 {
321 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
322
323 if (strindex == 0)
324 return "";
325
326 if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
327 return NULL;
328
329 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
330
331 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
332 {
333 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
334 {
335 /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
336 /* xgettext:c-format */
337 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: attempt to load strings from"
338 " a non-string section (number %d)"),
339 abfd, shindex);
340 return NULL;
341 }
342
343 if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
344 return NULL;
345 }
346 else
347 {
348 /* PR 24273: The string section's contents may have already
349 been loaded elsewhere, eg because a corrupt file has the
350 string section index in the ELF header pointing at a group
351 section. So be paranoid, and test that the last byte of
352 the section is zero. */
353 if (hdr->sh_size == 0 || hdr->contents[hdr->sh_size - 1] != 0)
354 return NULL;
355 }
356
357 if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
358 {
359 unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
360 _bfd_error_handler
361 /* xgettext:c-format */
362 (_("%pB: invalid string offset %u >= %" PRIu64 " for section `%s'"),
363 abfd, strindex, (uint64_t) hdr->sh_size,
364 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
365 ? ".shstrtab"
366 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
367 return NULL;
368 }
369
370 return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
371 }
372
373 /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
374 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
375 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
376 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
377 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
378 Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
379 or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
380
381 Elf_Internal_Sym *
382 bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
383 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
384 size_t symcount,
385 size_t symoffset,
386 Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
387 void *extsym_buf,
388 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
389 {
390 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
391 void *alloc_ext;
392 const bfd_byte *esym;
393 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
394 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
395 Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
396 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
397 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
398 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
399 size_t extsym_size;
400 size_t amt;
401 file_ptr pos;
402
403 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
404 abort ();
405
406 if (symcount == 0)
407 return intsym_buf;
408
409 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
410 shndx_hdr = NULL;
411 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd) != NULL)
412 {
413 elf_section_list * entry;
414 Elf_Internal_Shdr **sections = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
415
416 /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section. */
417 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
418 {
419 /* PR 20063. */
420 if (entry->hdr.sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
421 continue;
422
423 if (sections[entry->hdr.sh_link] == symtab_hdr)
424 {
425 shndx_hdr = & entry->hdr;
426 break;
427 };
428 }
429
430 if (shndx_hdr == NULL)
431 {
432 if (symtab_hdr == & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd))
433 /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work. */
434 shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)->hdr;
435 /* Otherwise we do nothing. The assumption is that
436 the index table will not be needed. */
437 }
438 }
439
440 /* Read the symbols. */
441 alloc_ext = NULL;
442 alloc_extshndx = NULL;
443 alloc_intsym = NULL;
444 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
445 extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
446 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount, extsym_size, &amt))
447 {
448 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
449 intsym_buf = NULL;
450 goto out;
451 }
452 pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
453 if (extsym_buf == NULL)
454 {
455 alloc_ext = bfd_malloc (amt);
456 extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
457 }
458 if (extsym_buf == NULL
459 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
460 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
461 {
462 intsym_buf = NULL;
463 goto out;
464 }
465
466 if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
467 extshndx_buf = NULL;
468 else
469 {
470 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx), &amt))
471 {
472 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
473 intsym_buf = NULL;
474 goto out;
475 }
476 pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
477 if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
478 {
479 alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *) bfd_malloc (amt);
480 extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
481 }
482 if (extshndx_buf == NULL
483 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
484 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
485 {
486 intsym_buf = NULL;
487 goto out;
488 }
489 }
490
491 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
492 {
493 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym), &amt))
494 {
495 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
496 goto out;
497 }
498 alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) bfd_malloc (amt);
499 intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
500 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
501 goto out;
502 }
503
504 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
505 isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
506 for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
507 shndx = extshndx_buf;
508 isym < isymend;
509 esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
510 if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
511 {
512 symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
513 /* xgettext:c-format */
514 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB symbol number %lu references"
515 " nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
516 ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
517 free (alloc_intsym);
518 intsym_buf = NULL;
519 goto out;
520 }
521
522 out:
523 free (alloc_ext);
524 free (alloc_extshndx);
525
526 return intsym_buf;
527 }
528
529 /* Look up a symbol name. */
530 const char *
531 bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
532 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
533 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
534 asection *sym_sec)
535 {
536 const char *name;
537 unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
538 unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
539
540 if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
541 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
542 && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
543 {
544 iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
545 shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
546 }
547
548 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
549 if (name == NULL)
550 name = "(null)";
551 else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
552 name = bfd_section_name (sym_sec);
553
554 return name;
555 }
556
557 /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
558 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
559 pointers. */
560
561 typedef union elf_internal_group {
562 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
563 unsigned int flags;
564 } Elf_Internal_Group;
565
566 /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
567 signature just a string? */
568
569 static const char *
570 group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
571 {
572 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
573 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
574 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
575 Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
576
577 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
578 that it is a symbol table section. */
579 if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
580 return NULL;
581 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
582 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
583 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
584 return NULL;
585
586 /* Go read the symbol. */
587 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
588 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
589 &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
590 return NULL;
591
592 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
593 }
594
595 /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
596
597 static bool
598 setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
599 {
600 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
601
602 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
603 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
604 if (num_group == 0)
605 {
606 unsigned int i, shnum;
607
608 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
609 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
610 shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
611 num_group = 0;
612
613 #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
614 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
615 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
616 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
617 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
618
619 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
620 {
621 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
622
623 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
624 num_group += 1;
625 }
626
627 if (num_group == 0)
628 {
629 num_group = (unsigned) -1;
630 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
631 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
632 }
633 else
634 {
635 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
636 so we can find them quickly. */
637 size_t amt;
638
639 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
640 amt = num_group * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *);
641 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr
642 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
643 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
644 return false;
645 num_group = 0;
646
647 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
648 {
649 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
650
651 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
652 {
653 unsigned char *src;
654 Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
655
656 /* Make sure the group section has a BFD section
657 attached to it. */
658 if (!bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
659 return false;
660
661 /* Add to list of sections. */
662 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
663 num_group += 1;
664
665 /* Read the raw contents. */
666 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4 && sizeof (*dest) % 4 == 0);
667 shdr->contents = NULL;
668 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (shdr->sh_size,
669 sizeof (*dest) / 4, &amt)
670 || bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
671 || !(shdr->contents
672 = _bfd_alloc_and_read (abfd, amt, shdr->sh_size)))
673 {
674 _bfd_error_handler
675 /* xgettext:c-format */
676 (_("%pB: invalid size field in group section"
677 " header: %#" PRIx64 ""),
678 abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
679 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
680 -- num_group;
681 continue;
682 }
683
684 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
685 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
686 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
687 pointers. */
688 src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
689 dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
690
691 while (1)
692 {
693 unsigned int idx;
694
695 src -= 4;
696 --dest;
697 idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
698 if (src == shdr->contents)
699 {
700 dest->shdr = NULL;
701 dest->flags = idx;
702 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
703 shdr->bfd_section->flags
704 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
705 break;
706 }
707 if (idx < shnum)
708 {
709 dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
710 /* PR binutils/23199: All sections in a
711 section group should be marked with
712 SHF_GROUP. But some tools generate
713 broken objects without SHF_GROUP. Fix
714 them up here. */
715 dest->shdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
716 }
717 if (idx >= shnum
718 || dest->shdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
719 {
720 _bfd_error_handler
721 (_("%pB: invalid entry in SHT_GROUP section [%u]"),
722 abfd, i);
723 dest->shdr = NULL;
724 }
725 }
726 }
727 }
728
729 /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
730 if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
731 {
732 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
733
734 /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
735 if (num_group == 0)
736 {
737 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
738 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
739 _bfd_error_handler
740 (_("%pB: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
741 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
742 }
743 }
744 }
745 }
746
747 if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
748 {
749 unsigned int search_offset = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset;
750 unsigned int j;
751
752 for (j = 0; j < num_group; j++)
753 {
754 /* Begin search from previous found group. */
755 unsigned i = (j + search_offset) % num_group;
756
757 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
758 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
759 bfd_size_type n_elt;
760
761 if (shdr == NULL)
762 continue;
763
764 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
765 if (idx == NULL || shdr->sh_size < 4)
766 {
767 /* See PR 21957 for a reproducer. */
768 /* xgettext:c-format */
769 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: group section '%pA' has no contents"),
770 abfd, shdr->bfd_section);
771 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i] = NULL;
772 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
773 return false;
774 }
775 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
776
777 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
778 section is a member. */
779 while (--n_elt != 0)
780 if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
781 {
782 asection *s = NULL;
783
784 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
785 other members to see if any others are linked via
786 next_in_group. */
787 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
788 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
789 while (--n_elt != 0)
790 if ((++idx)->shdr != NULL
791 && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
792 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
793 break;
794 if (n_elt != 0)
795 {
796 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
797 insert current section in circular list. */
798 elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
799 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
800 elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
801 }
802 else
803 {
804 const char *gname;
805
806 gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
807 if (gname == NULL)
808 return false;
809 elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
810
811 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
812 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
813 }
814
815 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
816 new member. */
817 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
818 elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
819
820 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset = i;
821 j = num_group - 1;
822 break;
823 }
824 }
825 }
826
827 if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
828 {
829 /* xgettext:c-format */
830 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: no group info for section '%pA'"),
831 abfd, newsect);
832 return false;
833 }
834 return true;
835 }
836
837 bool
838 _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
839 {
840 unsigned int i;
841 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
842 bool result = true;
843 asection *s;
844
845 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
846 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
847 {
848 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
849 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
850 {
851 unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
852 /* An sh_link value of 0 is now allowed. It indicates that linked
853 to section has already been discarded, but that the current
854 section has been retained for some other reason. This linking
855 section is still a candidate for later garbage collection
856 however. */
857 if (elfsec == 0)
858 {
859 elf_linked_to_section (s) = NULL;
860 }
861 else
862 {
863 asection *linksec = NULL;
864
865 if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
866 {
867 this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
868 linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
869 }
870
871 /* PR 1991, 2008:
872 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
873 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
874 if (linksec == NULL)
875 {
876 _bfd_error_handler
877 /* xgettext:c-format */
878 (_("%pB: sh_link [%d] in section `%pA' is incorrect"),
879 s->owner, elfsec, s);
880 result = false;
881 }
882
883 elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
884 }
885 }
886 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP
887 && elf_next_in_group (s) == NULL)
888 {
889 _bfd_error_handler
890 /* xgettext:c-format */
891 (_("%pB: SHT_GROUP section [index %d] has no SHF_GROUP sections"),
892 abfd, elf_section_data (s)->this_idx);
893 result = false;
894 }
895 }
896
897 /* Process section groups. */
898 if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
899 return result;
900
901 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
902 {
903 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
904 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
905 unsigned int n_elt;
906
907 /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
908 if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
909 {
910 _bfd_error_handler
911 /* xgettext:c-format */
912 (_("%pB: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
913 abfd, i);
914 result = false;
915 continue;
916 }
917
918 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
919 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
920
921 while (--n_elt != 0)
922 {
923 ++ idx;
924
925 if (idx->shdr == NULL)
926 continue;
927 else if (idx->shdr->bfd_section)
928 elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
929 else if (idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA
930 && idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_REL)
931 {
932 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
933 _bfd_error_handler
934 /* xgettext:c-format */
935 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s' in group [%pA]"),
936 abfd,
937 idx->shdr->sh_type,
938 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
939 (elf_elfheader (abfd)
940 ->e_shstrndx),
941 idx->shdr->sh_name),
942 shdr->bfd_section);
943 result = false;
944 }
945 }
946 }
947
948 return result;
949 }
950
951 bool
952 bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
953 {
954 return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
955 }
956
957 const char *
958 bfd_elf_group_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
959 {
960 if (elf_sec_group (sec) != NULL)
961 return elf_group_name (sec);
962 return NULL;
963 }
964
965 static char *
966 convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
967 {
968 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
969 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
970 if (new_name == NULL)
971 return NULL;
972 new_name[0] = '.';
973 new_name[1] = 'z';
974 memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
975 return new_name;
976 }
977
978 static char *
979 convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
980 {
981 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
982 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
983 if (new_name == NULL)
984 return NULL;
985 new_name[0] = '.';
986 memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
987 return new_name;
988 }
989
990 /* This a copy of lto_section defined in GCC (lto-streamer.h). */
991
992 struct lto_section
993 {
994 int16_t major_version;
995 int16_t minor_version;
996 unsigned char slim_object;
997
998 /* Flags is a private field that is not defined publicly. */
999 uint16_t flags;
1000 };
1001
1002 /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
1003 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
1004
1005 bool
1006 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1007 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1008 const char *name,
1009 int shindex)
1010 {
1011 asection *newsect;
1012 flagword flags;
1013 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1014 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
1015
1016 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
1017 return true;
1018
1019 newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
1020 if (newsect == NULL)
1021 return false;
1022
1023 hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
1024 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
1025 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
1026
1027 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
1028 elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
1029 elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
1030
1031 newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
1032
1033 flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
1034 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1035 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
1036 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
1037 flags |= SEC_GROUP;
1038 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
1039 {
1040 flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
1041 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1042 flags |= SEC_LOAD;
1043 }
1044 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
1045 flags |= SEC_READONLY;
1046 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
1047 flags |= SEC_CODE;
1048 else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1049 flags |= SEC_DATA;
1050 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
1051 {
1052 flags |= SEC_MERGE;
1053 newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
1054 }
1055 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
1056 flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
1057 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
1058 if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
1059 return false;
1060 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
1061 flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
1062 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
1063 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1064
1065 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI])
1066 {
1067 /* FIXME: We should not recognize SHF_GNU_MBIND for ELFOSABI_NONE,
1068 but binutils as of 2019-07-23 did not set the EI_OSABI header
1069 byte. */
1070 case ELFOSABI_GNU:
1071 case ELFOSABI_FREEBSD:
1072 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GNU_RETAIN) != 0)
1073 elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi |= elf_gnu_osabi_retain;
1074 /* Fall through */
1075 case ELFOSABI_NONE:
1076 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
1077 elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi |= elf_gnu_osabi_mbind;
1078 break;
1079 }
1080
1081 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
1082 {
1083 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
1084 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
1085 if (name [0] == '.')
1086 {
1087 if (startswith (name, ".debug")
1088 || startswith (name, ".gnu.debuglto_.debug_")
1089 || startswith (name, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.")
1090 || startswith (name, ".zdebug"))
1091 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING | SEC_ELF_OCTETS;
1092 else if (startswith (name, GNU_BUILD_ATTRS_SECTION_NAME)
1093 || startswith (name, ".note.gnu"))
1094 {
1095 flags |= SEC_ELF_OCTETS;
1096 opb = 1;
1097 }
1098 else if (startswith (name, ".line")
1099 || startswith (name, ".stab")
1100 || strcmp (name, ".gdb_index") == 0)
1101 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
1102 }
1103 }
1104
1105 if (!bfd_set_section_vma (newsect, hdr->sh_addr / opb)
1106 || !bfd_set_section_size (newsect, hdr->sh_size)
1107 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (newsect, bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
1108 return false;
1109
1110 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
1111 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
1112 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
1113 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
1114 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
1115 all but one of the sections. */
1116 if (startswith (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
1117 && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
1118 flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1119
1120 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, flags))
1121 return false;
1122
1123 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1124 if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
1125 if (!bed->elf_backend_section_flags (hdr))
1126 return false;
1127
1128 /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1129 separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1130 PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1131 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
1132 {
1133 bfd_byte *contents;
1134
1135 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
1136 return false;
1137
1138 elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size,
1139 hdr->sh_offset, hdr->sh_addralign);
1140 free (contents);
1141 }
1142
1143 if ((newsect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1144 {
1145 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
1146 unsigned int i, nload;
1147
1148 /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1149 p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1150 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1151 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1152 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1153 for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1154 if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
1155 break;
1156 else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
1157 ++nload;
1158 if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
1159 return true;
1160
1161 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1162 for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1163 {
1164 if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
1165 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
1166 || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
1167 && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
1168 {
1169 if ((newsect->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
1170 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1171 + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr) / opb;
1172 else
1173 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1174 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1175 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1176 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1177 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1178 segment will contain sections with contiguous
1179 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1180 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1181 + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset) / opb;
1182
1183 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1184 offsets whether a section with zero size should
1185 be placed at the end of one segment or the
1186 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1187 if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1188 && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1189 <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1190 break;
1191 }
1192 }
1193 }
1194
1195 /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1196 .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1197 if ((newsect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1198 && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1199 || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1200 {
1201 enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1202 int compression_header_size;
1203 bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
1204 unsigned int uncompressed_align_power;
1205 bool compressed
1206 = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
1207 &compression_header_size,
1208 &uncompressed_size,
1209 &uncompressed_align_power);
1210 if (compressed)
1211 {
1212 /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1213 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1214 action = decompress;
1215 }
1216
1217 /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1218 section. Check if we should compress. */
1219 if (action == nothing)
1220 {
1221 if (newsect->size != 0
1222 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
1223 && compression_header_size >= 0
1224 && uncompressed_size > 0
1225 && (!compressed
1226 || ((compression_header_size > 0)
1227 != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
1228 action = compress;
1229 else
1230 return true;
1231 }
1232
1233 if (action == compress)
1234 {
1235 if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1236 {
1237 _bfd_error_handler
1238 /* xgettext:c-format */
1239 (_("%pB: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1240 abfd, name);
1241 return false;
1242 }
1243 }
1244 else
1245 {
1246 if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1247 {
1248 _bfd_error_handler
1249 /* xgettext:c-format */
1250 (_("%pB: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1251 abfd, name);
1252 return false;
1253 }
1254 }
1255
1256 if (abfd->is_linker_input)
1257 {
1258 if (name[1] == 'z'
1259 && (action == decompress
1260 || (action == compress
1261 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
1262 {
1263 /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1264 that linker will consider this section as a debug
1265 section. */
1266 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
1267 if (new_name == NULL)
1268 return false;
1269 bfd_rename_section (newsect, new_name);
1270 }
1271 }
1272 else
1273 /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1274 section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1275 newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
1276 }
1277
1278 /* GCC uses .gnu.lto_.lto.<some_hash> as a LTO bytecode information
1279 section. */
1280 if (startswith (name, ".gnu.lto_.lto."))
1281 {
1282 struct lto_section lsection;
1283 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, newsect, &lsection, 0,
1284 sizeof (struct lto_section)))
1285 abfd->lto_slim_object = lsection.slim_object;
1286 }
1287
1288 return true;
1289 }
1290
1291 const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] =
1292 {
1293 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1294 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1295 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1296 };
1297
1298 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1299 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1300 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1301 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1302 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1303 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1304 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1305 function, or should call this function for relocatable output. */
1306
1307 bfd_reloc_status_type
1308 bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1309 arelent *reloc_entry,
1310 asymbol *symbol,
1311 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1312 asection *input_section,
1313 bfd *output_bfd,
1314 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1315 {
1316 if (output_bfd != NULL
1317 && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1318 && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1319 || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1320 {
1321 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1322 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1323 }
1324
1325 /* In some cases the relocation should be treated as output section
1326 relative, as when linking ELF DWARF into PE COFF. Many ELF
1327 targets lack section relative relocations and instead use
1328 ordinary absolute relocations for references between DWARF
1329 sections. That is arguably a bug in those targets but it happens
1330 to work for the usual case of linking to non-loaded ELF debug
1331 sections with VMAs forced to zero. PE COFF on the other hand
1332 doesn't allow a section VMA of zero. */
1333 if (output_bfd == NULL
1334 && !reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative
1335 && (symbol->section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
1336 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0)
1337 reloc_entry->addend -= symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1338
1339 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1340 }
1341 \f
1342 /* Returns TRUE if section A matches section B.
1343 Names, addresses and links may be different, but everything else
1344 should be the same. */
1345
1346 static bool
1347 section_match (const Elf_Internal_Shdr * a,
1348 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * b)
1349 {
1350 if (a->sh_type != b->sh_type
1351 || ((a->sh_flags ^ b->sh_flags) & ~SHF_INFO_LINK) != 0
1352 || a->sh_addralign != b->sh_addralign
1353 || a->sh_entsize != b->sh_entsize)
1354 return false;
1355 if (a->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
1356 || a->sh_type == SHT_STRTAB)
1357 return true;
1358 return a->sh_size == b->sh_size;
1359 }
1360
1361 /* Find a section in OBFD that has the same characteristics
1362 as IHEADER. Return the index of this section or SHN_UNDEF if
1363 none can be found. Check's section HINT first, as this is likely
1364 to be the correct section. */
1365
1366 static unsigned int
1367 find_link (const bfd *obfd, const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1368 const unsigned int hint)
1369 {
1370 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1371 unsigned int i;
1372
1373 BFD_ASSERT (iheader != NULL);
1374
1375 /* See PR 20922 for a reproducer of the NULL test. */
1376 if (hint < elf_numsections (obfd)
1377 && oheaders[hint] != NULL
1378 && section_match (oheaders[hint], iheader))
1379 return hint;
1380
1381 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1382 {
1383 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1384
1385 if (oheader == NULL)
1386 continue;
1387 if (section_match (oheader, iheader))
1388 /* FIXME: Do we care if there is a potential for
1389 multiple matches ? */
1390 return i;
1391 }
1392
1393 return SHN_UNDEF;
1394 }
1395
1396 /* PR 19938: Attempt to set the ELF section header fields of an OS or
1397 Processor specific section, based upon a matching input section.
1398 Returns TRUE upon success, FALSE otherwise. */
1399
1400 static bool
1401 copy_special_section_fields (const bfd *ibfd,
1402 bfd *obfd,
1403 const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1404 Elf_Internal_Shdr *oheader,
1405 const unsigned int secnum)
1406 {
1407 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1408 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1409 bool changed = false;
1410 unsigned int sh_link;
1411
1412 if (oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
1413 {
1414 /* This is a feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:
1415 When a section's type is changed to NOBITS, we preserve
1416 the sh_link and sh_info fields so that they can be
1417 matched up with the original.
1418
1419 Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1420 The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1421 relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1422 the same location as they were in the input BFD. But
1423 the whole point of this action is to preserve the
1424 original values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so
1425 that they can be matched up with the section headers in
1426 the original file. So strictly speaking we may be
1427 creating an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file
1428 that just contains debug info and only for sections
1429 without any contents. */
1430 if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
1431 oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
1432 if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
1433 oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
1434 return true;
1435 }
1436
1437 /* Allow the target a chance to decide how these fields should be set. */
1438 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd,
1439 iheader, oheader))
1440 return true;
1441
1442 /* We have an iheader which might match oheader, and which has non-zero
1443 sh_info and/or sh_link fields. Attempt to follow those links and find
1444 the section in the output bfd which corresponds to the linked section
1445 in the input bfd. */
1446 if (iheader->sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1447 {
1448 /* See PR 20931 for a reproducer. */
1449 if (iheader->sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
1450 {
1451 _bfd_error_handler
1452 /* xgettext:c-format */
1453 (_("%pB: invalid sh_link field (%d) in section number %d"),
1454 ibfd, iheader->sh_link, secnum);
1455 return false;
1456 }
1457
1458 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_link], iheader->sh_link);
1459 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1460 {
1461 oheader->sh_link = sh_link;
1462 changed = true;
1463 }
1464 else
1465 /* FIXME: Should we install iheader->sh_link
1466 if we could not find a match ? */
1467 _bfd_error_handler
1468 /* xgettext:c-format */
1469 (_("%pB: failed to find link section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1470 }
1471
1472 if (iheader->sh_info)
1473 {
1474 /* The sh_info field can hold arbitrary information, but if the
1475 SHF_LINK_INFO flag is set then it should be interpreted as a
1476 section index. */
1477 if (iheader->sh_flags & SHF_INFO_LINK)
1478 {
1479 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_info],
1480 iheader->sh_info);
1481 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1482 oheader->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
1483 }
1484 else
1485 /* No idea what it means - just copy it. */
1486 sh_link = iheader->sh_info;
1487
1488 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1489 {
1490 oheader->sh_info = sh_link;
1491 changed = true;
1492 }
1493 else
1494 _bfd_error_handler
1495 /* xgettext:c-format */
1496 (_("%pB: failed to find info section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1497 }
1498
1499 return changed;
1500 }
1501
1502 /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1503 another. */
1504
1505 bool
1506 _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1507 {
1508 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1509 Elf_Internal_Shdr **oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1510 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1511 unsigned int i;
1512
1513 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1514 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1515 return true;
1516
1517 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
1518 {
1519 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1520 elf_flags_init (obfd) = true;
1521 }
1522
1523 elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1524
1525 /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1526 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
1527 elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
1528
1529 /* If set, copy the EI_ABIVERSION field. */
1530 if (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION])
1531 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION]
1532 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION];
1533
1534 /* Copy object attributes. */
1535 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1536
1537 if (iheaders == NULL || oheaders == NULL)
1538 return true;
1539
1540 bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1541
1542 /* Possibly copy other fields in the section header. */
1543 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1544 {
1545 unsigned int j;
1546 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1547
1548 /* Ignore ordinary sections. SHT_NOBITS sections are considered however
1549 because of a special case need for generating separate debug info
1550 files. See below for more details. */
1551 if (oheader == NULL
1552 || (oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
1553 && oheader->sh_type < SHT_LOOS))
1554 continue;
1555
1556 /* Ignore empty sections, and sections whose
1557 fields have already been initialised. */
1558 if (oheader->sh_size == 0
1559 || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
1560 continue;
1561
1562 /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1563 First we try for a direct mapping between the input and output sections. */
1564 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1565 {
1566 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1567
1568 if (iheader == NULL)
1569 continue;
1570
1571 if (oheader->bfd_section != NULL
1572 && iheader->bfd_section != NULL
1573 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section != NULL
1574 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section == oheader->bfd_section)
1575 {
1576 /* We have found a connection from the input section to the
1577 output section. Attempt to copy the header fields. If
1578 this fails then do not try any further sections - there
1579 should only be a one-to-one mapping between input and output. */
1580 if (! copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1581 j = elf_numsections (ibfd);
1582 break;
1583 }
1584 }
1585
1586 if (j < elf_numsections (ibfd))
1587 continue;
1588
1589 /* That failed. So try to deduce the corresponding input section.
1590 Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1591 is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1592 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1593 {
1594 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1595
1596 if (iheader == NULL)
1597 continue;
1598
1599 /* Try matching fields in the input section's header.
1600 Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections into
1601 SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type matches any
1602 input type. */
1603 if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
1604 || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
1605 && (iheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1606 == (oheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1607 && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
1608 && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
1609 && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
1610 && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
1611 && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
1612 || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
1613 {
1614 if (copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1615 break;
1616 }
1617 }
1618
1619 if (j == elf_numsections (ibfd) && oheader->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS)
1620 {
1621 /* Final attempt. Call the backend copy function
1622 with a NULL input section. */
1623 (void) bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd,
1624 NULL, oheader);
1625 }
1626 }
1627
1628 return true;
1629 }
1630
1631 static const char *
1632 get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1633 {
1634 const char *pt;
1635 switch (p_type)
1636 {
1637 case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1638 case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1639 case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1640 case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1641 case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1642 case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1643 case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1644 case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1645 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1646 case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1647 case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1648 default: pt = NULL; break;
1649 }
1650 return pt;
1651 }
1652
1653 /* Print out the program headers. */
1654
1655 bool
1656 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1657 {
1658 FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1659 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1660 asection *s;
1661 bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1662
1663 p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1664 if (p != NULL)
1665 {
1666 unsigned int i, c;
1667
1668 fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1669 c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1670 for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1671 {
1672 const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1673 char buf[20];
1674
1675 if (pt == NULL)
1676 {
1677 sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1678 pt = buf;
1679 }
1680 fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1681 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1682 fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1683 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1684 fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1685 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1686 fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1687 fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1688 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1689 fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1690 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1691 fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1692 (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1693 (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1694 (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1695 if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1696 fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1697 fprintf (f, "\n");
1698 }
1699 }
1700
1701 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1702 if (s != NULL)
1703 {
1704 unsigned int elfsec;
1705 unsigned long shlink;
1706 bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1707 size_t extdynsize;
1708 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1709
1710 fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1711
1712 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1713 goto error_return;
1714
1715 elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1716 if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1717 goto error_return;
1718 shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1719
1720 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1721 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1722
1723 extdyn = dynbuf;
1724 /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1725 if (s->size < extdynsize)
1726 goto error_return;
1727 extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1728 /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1729 Fix range check. */
1730 for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
1731 {
1732 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1733 const char *name = "";
1734 char ab[20];
1735 bool stringp;
1736 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1737
1738 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1739
1740 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1741 break;
1742
1743 stringp = false;
1744 switch (dyn.d_tag)
1745 {
1746 default:
1747 if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1748 name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1749
1750 if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1751 {
1752 sprintf (ab, "%#" BFD_VMA_FMT "x", dyn.d_tag);
1753 name = ab;
1754 }
1755 break;
1756
1757 case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = true; break;
1758 case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1759 case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1760 case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1761 case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1762 case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1763 case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1764 case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1765 case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1766 case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1767 case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1768 case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1769 case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1770 case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = true; break;
1771 case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = true; break;
1772 case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1773 case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1774 case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1775 case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1776 case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1777 case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1778 case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1779 case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1780 case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1781 case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1782 case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1783 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1784 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1785 case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = true; break;
1786 case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1787 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1788 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1789 case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1790 case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1791 case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1792 case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1793 case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1794 case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1795 case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1796 case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1797 case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = true; break;
1798 case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = true; break;
1799 case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = true; break;
1800 case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1801 case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1802 case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1803 case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1804 case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1805 case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1806 case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1807 case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1808 case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1809 case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1810 case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1811 case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = true; break;
1812 case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1813 case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = true; break;
1814 case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1815 }
1816
1817 fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1818 if (! stringp)
1819 {
1820 fprintf (f, "0x");
1821 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1822 }
1823 else
1824 {
1825 const char *string;
1826 unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1827
1828 string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1829 if (string == NULL)
1830 goto error_return;
1831 fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1832 }
1833 fprintf (f, "\n");
1834 }
1835
1836 free (dynbuf);
1837 dynbuf = NULL;
1838 }
1839
1840 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1841 || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1842 {
1843 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, false))
1844 return false;
1845 }
1846
1847 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1848 {
1849 Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1850
1851 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1852 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1853 {
1854 fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1855 t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1856 t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1857 if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1858 {
1859 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1860
1861 fprintf (f, "\t");
1862 for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1863 a != NULL;
1864 a = a->vda_nextptr)
1865 fprintf (f, "%s ",
1866 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1867 fprintf (f, "\n");
1868 }
1869 }
1870 }
1871
1872 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1873 {
1874 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1875
1876 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1877 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1878 {
1879 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1880
1881 fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1882 t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1883 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1884 fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1885 a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1886 a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1887 }
1888 }
1889
1890 return true;
1891
1892 error_return:
1893 free (dynbuf);
1894 return false;
1895 }
1896
1897 /* Get version name. If BASE_P is TRUE, return "Base" for VER_FLG_BASE
1898 and return symbol version for symbol version itself. */
1899
1900 const char *
1901 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1902 bool base_p,
1903 bool *hidden)
1904 {
1905 const char *version_string = NULL;
1906 if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
1907 && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
1908 {
1909 unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
1910
1911 *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
1912 vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
1913
1914 if (vernum == 0)
1915 version_string = "";
1916 else if (vernum == 1
1917 && (vernum > elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs
1918 || (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[0].vd_flags
1919 == VER_FLG_BASE)))
1920 version_string = base_p ? "Base" : "";
1921 else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1922 {
1923 const char *nodename
1924 = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1925 version_string = "";
1926 if (base_p
1927 || nodename == NULL
1928 || symbol->name == NULL
1929 || strcmp (symbol->name, nodename) != 0)
1930 version_string = nodename;
1931 }
1932 else
1933 {
1934 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1935
1936 version_string = _("<corrupt>");
1937 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1938 t != NULL;
1939 t = t->vn_nextref)
1940 {
1941 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1942
1943 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1944 {
1945 if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1946 {
1947 version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1948 break;
1949 }
1950 }
1951 }
1952 }
1953 }
1954 return version_string;
1955 }
1956
1957 /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1958
1959 void
1960 bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1961 void *filep,
1962 asymbol *symbol,
1963 bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1964 {
1965 FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1966 switch (how)
1967 {
1968 case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1969 fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1970 break;
1971 case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1972 fprintf (file, "elf ");
1973 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1974 fprintf (file, " %x", symbol->flags);
1975 break;
1976 case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1977 {
1978 const char *section_name;
1979 const char *name = NULL;
1980 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1981 unsigned char st_other;
1982 bfd_vma val;
1983 const char *version_string;
1984 bool hidden;
1985
1986 section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1987
1988 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1989 if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1990 name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1991
1992 if (name == NULL)
1993 {
1994 name = symbol->name;
1995 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1996 }
1997
1998 fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1999 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
2000 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
2001 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
2002 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
2003 if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
2004 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
2005 else
2006 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
2007 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
2008
2009 /* If we have version information, print it. */
2010 version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
2011 symbol,
2012 true,
2013 &hidden);
2014 if (version_string)
2015 {
2016 if (!hidden)
2017 fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
2018 else
2019 {
2020 int i;
2021
2022 fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
2023 for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
2024 putc (' ', file);
2025 }
2026 }
2027
2028 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
2029 st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
2030
2031 switch (st_other)
2032 {
2033 case 0: break;
2034 case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
2035 case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
2036 case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
2037 default:
2038 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
2039 everything hex. */
2040 fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
2041 }
2042
2043 fprintf (file, " %s", name);
2044 }
2045 break;
2046 }
2047 }
2048 \f
2049 /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
2050
2051 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
2052
2053 bool
2054 bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
2055 {
2056 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
2057 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
2058 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2059 const char *name;
2060 bool ret = true;
2061
2062 if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2063 return false;
2064
2065 /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a loop of sections via
2066 sh_link or sh_info. Detect this here, by refusing to load a
2067 section that we are already in the process of loading. */
2068 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->being_created[shindex])
2069 {
2070 _bfd_error_handler
2071 (_("%pB: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
2072 return false;
2073 }
2074 elf_tdata (abfd)->being_created[shindex] = true;
2075
2076 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
2077 ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
2078 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
2079 hdr->sh_name);
2080 if (name == NULL)
2081 goto fail;
2082
2083 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2084 switch (hdr->sh_type)
2085 {
2086 case SHT_NULL:
2087 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
2088 goto success;
2089
2090 case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
2091 case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
2092 case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
2093 case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
2094 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
2095 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
2096 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
2097 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
2098 case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
2099 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2100 goto success;
2101
2102 case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
2103 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2104 goto fail;
2105
2106 if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
2107 {
2108 /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
2109 field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
2110 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
2111 {
2112 case bfd_arch_i386:
2113 case bfd_arch_sparc:
2114 if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
2115 || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
2116 break;
2117 /* Otherwise fall through. */
2118 default:
2119 goto fail;
2120 }
2121 }
2122 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
2123 goto fail;
2124 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
2125 {
2126 Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
2127
2128 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
2129 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
2130 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
2131 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2132 {
2133 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
2134 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2135 }
2136 else
2137 {
2138 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2139
2140 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2141 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2142 {
2143 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2144 if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2145 {
2146 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2147 break;
2148 }
2149 }
2150 }
2151 }
2152 goto success;
2153
2154 case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table. */
2155 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2156 goto success;
2157
2158 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2159 goto fail;
2160
2161 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2162 {
2163 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2164 goto fail;
2165 /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2166 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2167 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2168 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2169 goto success;
2170 }
2171
2172 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
2173 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2174 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) != 0)
2175 {
2176 _bfd_error_handler
2177 /* xgettext:c-format */
2178 (_("%pB: warning: multiple symbol tables detected"
2179 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2180 abfd, shindex);
2181 goto success;
2182 }
2183 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2184 elf_symtab_hdr (abfd) = *hdr;
2185 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2186 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2187
2188 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
2189 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
2190 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
2191 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
2192 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
2193 linker. */
2194 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
2195 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
2196 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2197 shindex))
2198 goto fail;
2199
2200 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
2201 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
2202 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
2203 {
2204 elf_section_list * entry;
2205 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2206
2207 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2208 if (entry->hdr.sh_link == shindex)
2209 goto success;
2210
2211 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2212 for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2213 {
2214 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2215
2216 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2217 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2218 break;
2219 }
2220
2221 if (i == num_sec)
2222 for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
2223 {
2224 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2225
2226 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2227 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2228 break;
2229 }
2230
2231 if (i != shindex)
2232 ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
2233 /* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
2234 goto success;
2235 }
2236
2237 case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
2238 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2239 goto success;
2240
2241 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2242 goto fail;
2243
2244 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2245 {
2246 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2247 goto fail;
2248
2249 /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2250 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2251 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2252 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2253 goto success;
2254 }
2255
2256 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
2257 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2258 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2259 {
2260 _bfd_error_handler
2261 /* xgettext:c-format */
2262 (_("%pB: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected"
2263 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2264 abfd, shindex);
2265 goto success;
2266 }
2267 elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2268 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
2269 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
2270 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2271
2272 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
2273 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
2274 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2275 goto success;
2276
2277 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
2278 {
2279 elf_section_list * entry;
2280
2281 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2282 if (entry->ndx == shindex)
2283 goto success;
2284
2285 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
2286 if (entry == NULL)
2287 goto fail;
2288 entry->ndx = shindex;
2289 entry->hdr = * hdr;
2290 entry->next = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
2291 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
2292 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = & entry->hdr;
2293 goto success;
2294 }
2295
2296 case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table. */
2297 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
2298 goto success;
2299
2300 if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
2301 {
2302 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2303 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
2304 goto success;
2305 }
2306
2307 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2308 {
2309 symtab_strtab:
2310 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
2311 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
2312 goto success;
2313 }
2314
2315 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2316 {
2317 dynsymtab_strtab:
2318 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2319 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
2320 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
2321 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2322 can handle it. */
2323 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2324 shindex);
2325 goto success;
2326 }
2327
2328 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2329 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2330 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2331 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
2332 {
2333 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2334
2335 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2336 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2337 {
2338 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2339 if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2340 {
2341 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2342 if (i == shindex)
2343 goto fail;
2344 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
2345 goto fail;
2346 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
2347 goto symtab_strtab;
2348 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
2349 goto dynsymtab_strtab;
2350 }
2351 }
2352 }
2353 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2354 goto success;
2355
2356 case SHT_REL:
2357 case SHT_RELA:
2358 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2359 {
2360 asection *target_sect;
2361 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
2362 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2363 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
2364
2365 if (hdr->sh_entsize
2366 != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
2367 ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
2368 goto fail;
2369
2370 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2371 if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
2372 {
2373 _bfd_error_handler
2374 /* xgettext:c-format */
2375 (_("%pB: invalid link %u for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2376 abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex);
2377 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2378 shindex);
2379 goto success;
2380 }
2381
2382 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2383 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2384 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2385 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2386 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2387 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2388 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2389
2390 Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2391 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
2392 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
2393 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
2394 {
2395 unsigned int scan;
2396 int found;
2397
2398 found = 0;
2399 for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
2400 {
2401 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2402 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2403 {
2404 if (found != 0)
2405 {
2406 found = 0;
2407 break;
2408 }
2409 found = scan;
2410 }
2411 }
2412 if (found != 0)
2413 hdr->sh_link = found;
2414 }
2415
2416 /* Get the symbol table. */
2417 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2418 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2419 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
2420 goto fail;
2421
2422 /* If this is an alloc section in an executable or shared
2423 library, or the reloc section does not use the main symbol
2424 table we don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't
2425 adequately represent such a section, so at least for now,
2426 we don't try. We just present it as a normal section. We
2427 also can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the
2428 null section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or
2429 its sh_link points to the null section. */
2430 if (((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) != 0
2431 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2432 || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
2433 || hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
2434 || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
2435 || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
2436 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
2437 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2438 {
2439 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2440 shindex);
2441 goto success;
2442 }
2443
2444 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
2445 goto fail;
2446
2447 target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
2448 if (target_sect == NULL)
2449 goto fail;
2450
2451 esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
2452 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2453 p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
2454 else
2455 p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
2456
2457 /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7.
2458 Also see PR 24456, for a file which deliberately has two reloc
2459 sections. */
2460 if (*p_hdr != NULL)
2461 {
2462 if (!bed->init_secondary_reloc_section (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2463 {
2464 _bfd_error_handler
2465 /* xgettext:c-format */
2466 (_("%pB: warning: secondary relocation section '%s' "
2467 "for section %pA found - ignoring"),
2468 abfd, name, target_sect);
2469 }
2470 goto success;
2471 }
2472
2473 hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*hdr2));
2474 if (hdr2 == NULL)
2475 goto fail;
2476 *hdr2 = *hdr;
2477 *p_hdr = hdr2;
2478 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
2479 target_sect->reloc_count += (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr)
2480 * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
2481 target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
2482 target_sect->relocation = NULL;
2483 target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
2484 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2485 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2486 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2487 {
2488 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2489 target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
2490 }
2491 abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
2492 goto success;
2493 }
2494
2495 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2496 elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
2497 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
2498 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2499 goto success;
2500
2501 case SHT_GNU_versym:
2502 if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
2503 goto fail;
2504
2505 elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
2506 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
2507 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2508 goto success;
2509
2510 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2511 elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
2512 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
2513 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2514 goto success;
2515
2516 case SHT_SHLIB:
2517 goto success;
2518
2519 case SHT_GROUP:
2520 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
2521 goto fail;
2522
2523 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2524 goto fail;
2525
2526 goto success;
2527
2528 default:
2529 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2530 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2531 || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
2532 {
2533 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2534 goto fail;
2535 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
2536 goto success;
2537 }
2538
2539 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2540 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2541 goto success;
2542
2543 if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
2544 {
2545 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2546 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2547 for applications? */
2548 _bfd_error_handler
2549 /* xgettext:c-format */
2550 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2551 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2552 else
2553 {
2554 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2555 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2556 shindex);
2557 goto success;
2558 }
2559 }
2560 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
2561 && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
2562 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2563 _bfd_error_handler
2564 /* xgettext:c-format */
2565 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2566 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2567 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
2568 {
2569 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2570 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
2571 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2572 required to correctly process the section and the file should
2573 be rejected with an error message. */
2574 _bfd_error_handler
2575 /* xgettext:c-format */
2576 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2577 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2578 else
2579 {
2580 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2581 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2582 goto success;
2583 }
2584 }
2585 else
2586 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2587 _bfd_error_handler
2588 /* xgettext:c-format */
2589 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2590 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2591
2592 goto fail;
2593 }
2594
2595 fail:
2596 ret = false;
2597 success:
2598 elf_tdata (abfd)->being_created[shindex] = false;
2599 return ret;
2600 }
2601
2602 /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2603
2604 Elf_Internal_Sym *
2605 bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2606 bfd *abfd,
2607 unsigned long r_symndx)
2608 {
2609 unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2610
2611 if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2612 {
2613 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2614 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2615 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2616
2617 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2618 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2619 &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2620 return NULL;
2621
2622 if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2623 {
2624 memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2625 cache->abfd = abfd;
2626 }
2627 cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2628 }
2629
2630 return &cache->sym[ent];
2631 }
2632
2633 /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2634 section. */
2635
2636 asection *
2637 bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2638 {
2639 if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2640 return NULL;
2641 return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2642 }
2643
2644 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2645 {
2646 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2647 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2648 };
2649
2650 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2651 {
2652 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2653 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ctf"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2654 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2655 };
2656
2657 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2658 {
2659 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2660 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2661 /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2662 unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2663 attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2664 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2665 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2666 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2667 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2668 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2669 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2670 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2671 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2672 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2673 };
2674
2675 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2676 {
2677 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2678 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), -2, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2679 { NULL, 0 , 0, 0, 0 }
2680 };
2681
2682 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2683 {
2684 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2685 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.n"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2686 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.p"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2687 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2688 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2689 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2690 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2691 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2692 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2693 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2694 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2695 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2696 };
2697
2698 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2699 {
2700 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2701 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2702 };
2703
2704 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2705 {
2706 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2707 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), -2, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2708 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2709 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2710 };
2711
2712 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2713 {
2714 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2715 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2716 };
2717
2718 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2719 {
2720 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".noinit"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2721 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2722 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2723 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2724 };
2725
2726 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2727 {
2728 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".persistent.bss"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2729 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".persistent"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2730 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), -2, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2731 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2732 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2733 };
2734
2735 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2736 {
2737 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2738 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2739 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2740 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2741 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2742 };
2743
2744 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2745 {
2746 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2747 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2748 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2749 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2750 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2751 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2752 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2753 };
2754
2755 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2756 {
2757 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2758 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2759 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2760 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2761 };
2762
2763 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2764 {
2765 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2766 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2767 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2768 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2769 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2770 };
2771
2772 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2773 {
2774 special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2775 special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2776 special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2777 NULL, /* 'e' */
2778 special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2779 special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2780 special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2781 special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2782 NULL, /* 'j' */
2783 NULL, /* 'k' */
2784 special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2785 NULL, /* 'm' */
2786 special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2787 NULL, /* 'o' */
2788 special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2789 NULL, /* 'q' */
2790 special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2791 special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2792 special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2793 NULL, /* 'u' */
2794 NULL, /* 'v' */
2795 NULL, /* 'w' */
2796 NULL, /* 'x' */
2797 NULL, /* 'y' */
2798 special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2799 };
2800
2801 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2802 _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2803 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2804 unsigned int rela)
2805 {
2806 int i;
2807 int len;
2808
2809 len = strlen (name);
2810
2811 for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2812 {
2813 int suffix_len;
2814 int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2815
2816 if (len < prefix_len)
2817 continue;
2818 if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2819 continue;
2820
2821 suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2822 if (suffix_len <= 0)
2823 {
2824 if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2825 {
2826 if (suffix_len == 0)
2827 continue;
2828 if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2829 && (suffix_len == -2
2830 || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2831 continue;
2832 }
2833 }
2834 else
2835 {
2836 if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2837 continue;
2838 if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2839 spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2840 suffix_len) != 0)
2841 continue;
2842 }
2843 return &spec[i];
2844 }
2845
2846 return NULL;
2847 }
2848
2849 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2850 _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2851 {
2852 int i;
2853 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2854 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2855
2856 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2857 if (sec->name == NULL)
2858 return NULL;
2859
2860 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2861 spec = bed->special_sections;
2862 if (spec)
2863 {
2864 spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2865 bed->special_sections,
2866 sec->use_rela_p);
2867 if (spec != NULL)
2868 return spec;
2869 }
2870
2871 if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2872 return NULL;
2873
2874 i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2875 if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2876 return NULL;
2877
2878 spec = special_sections[i];
2879
2880 if (spec == NULL)
2881 return NULL;
2882
2883 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2884 }
2885
2886 bool
2887 _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2888 {
2889 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2890 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2891 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2892
2893 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2894 if (sdata == NULL)
2895 {
2896 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2897 sizeof (*sdata));
2898 if (sdata == NULL)
2899 return false;
2900 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2901 }
2902
2903 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2904 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2905 sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2906
2907 /* Set up ELF section type and flags for newly created sections, if
2908 there is an ABI mandated section. */
2909 ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2910 if (ssect != NULL)
2911 {
2912 elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2913 elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2914 }
2915
2916 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2917 }
2918
2919 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2920
2921 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2922 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2923 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2924 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2925
2926 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2927 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2928 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2929 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2930 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2931 of combined data+bss.
2932
2933 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2934 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2935 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2936 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2937 into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2938
2939 */
2940
2941 bool
2942 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2943 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2944 int hdr_index,
2945 const char *type_name)
2946 {
2947 asection *newsect;
2948 char *name;
2949 char namebuf[64];
2950 size_t len;
2951 int split;
2952 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
2953
2954 split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2955 && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2956 && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2957
2958 if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2959 {
2960 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2961 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2962 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2963 if (!name)
2964 return false;
2965 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2966 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2967 if (newsect == NULL)
2968 return false;
2969 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr / opb;
2970 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr / opb;
2971 newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2972 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2973 newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2974 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2975 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2976 {
2977 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2978 newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2979 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2980 {
2981 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2982 may be data. */
2983 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2984 }
2985 }
2986 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2987 {
2988 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2989 }
2990 }
2991
2992 if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
2993 {
2994 bfd_vma align;
2995
2996 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
2997 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2998 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2999 if (!name)
3000 return false;
3001 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
3002 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
3003 if (newsect == NULL)
3004 return false;
3005 newsect->vma = (hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz) / opb;
3006 newsect->lma = (hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz) / opb;
3007 newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
3008 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
3009 align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
3010 if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
3011 align = hdr->p_align;
3012 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
3013 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
3014 {
3015 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
3016 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
3017 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
3018 }
3019 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
3020 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
3021 }
3022
3023 return true;
3024 }
3025
3026 static bool
3027 _bfd_elf_core_find_build_id (bfd *templ, bfd_vma offset)
3028 {
3029 /* The return value is ignored. Build-ids are considered optional. */
3030 if (templ->xvec->flavour == bfd_target_elf_flavour)
3031 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_core_find_build_id)
3032 (templ, offset);
3033 return false;
3034 }
3035
3036 bool
3037 bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
3038 {
3039 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3040
3041 switch (hdr->p_type)
3042 {
3043 case PT_NULL:
3044 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
3045
3046 case PT_LOAD:
3047 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load"))
3048 return false;
3049 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core && abfd->build_id == NULL)
3050 _bfd_elf_core_find_build_id (abfd, hdr->p_offset);
3051 return true;
3052
3053 case PT_DYNAMIC:
3054 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
3055
3056 case PT_INTERP:
3057 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
3058
3059 case PT_NOTE:
3060 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
3061 return false;
3062 if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz,
3063 hdr->p_align))
3064 return false;
3065 return true;
3066
3067 case PT_SHLIB:
3068 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
3069
3070 case PT_PHDR:
3071 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
3072
3073 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
3074 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
3075 "eh_frame_hdr");
3076
3077 case PT_GNU_STACK:
3078 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
3079
3080 case PT_GNU_RELRO:
3081 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
3082
3083 default:
3084 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
3085 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3086 return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
3087 }
3088 }
3089
3090 /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
3091 REL or RELA. */
3092
3093 Elf_Internal_Shdr *
3094 _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
3095 {
3096 if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
3097 {
3098 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
3099 return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
3100 }
3101 else
3102 return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
3103 }
3104
3105 static bool
3106 _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
3107 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
3108 const char *sec_name,
3109 bool use_rela_p)
3110 {
3111 char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
3112 sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
3113 if (name == NULL)
3114 return false;
3115
3116 sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
3117 rel_hdr->sh_name =
3118 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
3119 false);
3120 if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3121 return false;
3122
3123 return true;
3124 }
3125
3126 /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
3127 containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
3128 USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
3129 relocations. */
3130
3131 static bool
3132 _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
3133 struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
3134 const char *sec_name,
3135 bool use_rela_p,
3136 bool delay_st_name_p)
3137 {
3138 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
3139 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3140
3141 BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
3142 rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*rel_hdr));
3143 reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
3144
3145 if (delay_st_name_p)
3146 rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3147 else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
3148 use_rela_p))
3149 return false;
3150 rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
3151 rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
3152 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
3153 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
3154 rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
3155 rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3156 rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3157 rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3158 rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3159
3160 return true;
3161 }
3162
3163 /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
3164
3165 int
3166 bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
3167 {
3168 if ((flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_IS_COMMON)) != 0
3169 && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
3170 return SHT_NOBITS;
3171 return SHT_PROGBITS;
3172 }
3173
3174 struct fake_section_arg
3175 {
3176 struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
3177 bool failed;
3178 };
3179
3180 /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
3181
3182 static void
3183 elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
3184 {
3185 struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
3186 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3187 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
3188 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
3189 unsigned int sh_type;
3190 const char *name = asect->name;
3191 bool delay_st_name_p = false;
3192 bfd_vma mask;
3193
3194 if (arg->failed)
3195 {
3196 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
3197 loop. */
3198 return;
3199 }
3200
3201 this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
3202
3203 if (arg->link_info)
3204 {
3205 /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
3206 if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
3207 && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
3208 && name[1] == 'd'
3209 && name[6] == '_')
3210 {
3211 /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
3212 compressed. */
3213 asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
3214 /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding section
3215 name to section name section after it is compressed in
3216 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3217 delay_st_name_p = true;
3218 }
3219 }
3220 else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
3221 {
3222 /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
3223 if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
3224 {
3225 /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
3226 convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
3227 needed. */
3228 if (name[1] == 'z')
3229 {
3230 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
3231 if (new_name == NULL)
3232 {
3233 arg->failed = true;
3234 return;
3235 }
3236 name = new_name;
3237 }
3238 }
3239 else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
3240 {
3241 /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
3242 section smaller. So only rename the section when
3243 compression has actually taken place. If input section
3244 name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
3245 char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
3246 if (new_name == NULL)
3247 {
3248 arg->failed = true;
3249 return;
3250 }
3251 BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
3252 name = new_name;
3253 }
3254 }
3255
3256 if (delay_st_name_p)
3257 this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3258 else
3259 {
3260 this_hdr->sh_name
3261 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3262 name, false);
3263 if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3264 {
3265 arg->failed = true;
3266 return;
3267 }
3268 }
3269
3270 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
3271
3272 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3273 || asect->user_set_vma)
3274 this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, asect);
3275 else
3276 this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3277
3278 this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3279 this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
3280 this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3281 /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
3282 if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
3283 {
3284 _bfd_error_handler
3285 /* xgettext:c-format */
3286 (_("%pB: error: alignment power %d of section `%pA' is too big"),
3287 abfd, asect->alignment_power, asect);
3288 arg->failed = true;
3289 return;
3290 }
3291 /* Set sh_addralign to the highest power of two given by alignment
3292 consistent with the section VMA. Linker scripts can force VMA. */
3293 mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power) | this_hdr->sh_addr;
3294 this_hdr->sh_addralign = mask & -mask;
3295 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
3296 copy_private_section_data. */
3297
3298 this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
3299 this_hdr->contents = NULL;
3300
3301 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
3302 asect->flags. */
3303 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
3304 sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
3305 else
3306 sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
3307
3308 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
3309 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3310 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
3311 && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
3312 && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3313 {
3314 /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
3315 allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
3316 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
3317 to a bss output section via a linker script. */
3318 _bfd_error_handler
3319 (_("warning: section `%pA' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
3320 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3321 }
3322
3323 switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
3324 {
3325 default:
3326 break;
3327
3328 case SHT_STRTAB:
3329 case SHT_NOTE:
3330 case SHT_NOBITS:
3331 case SHT_PROGBITS:
3332 break;
3333
3334 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
3335 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
3336 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
3337 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
3338 break;
3339
3340 case SHT_HASH:
3341 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
3342 break;
3343
3344 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3345 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
3346 break;
3347
3348 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3349 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
3350 break;
3351
3352 case SHT_RELA:
3353 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
3354 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3355 break;
3356
3357 case SHT_REL:
3358 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
3359 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
3360 break;
3361
3362 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3363 this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
3364 break;
3365
3366 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3367 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3368 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3369 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3370 zero. */
3371 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3372 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
3373 else
3374 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
3375 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
3376 break;
3377
3378 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3379 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3380 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3381 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3382 zero. */
3383 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3384 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
3385 else
3386 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
3387 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
3388 break;
3389
3390 case SHT_GROUP:
3391 this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
3392 break;
3393
3394 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3395 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
3396 break;
3397 }
3398
3399 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3400 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
3401 if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3402 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
3403 if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
3404 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
3405 if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
3406 {
3407 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
3408 this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
3409 }
3410 if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
3411 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
3412 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
3413 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3414 if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
3415 {
3416 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
3417 if (asect->size == 0
3418 && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
3419 {
3420 struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
3421
3422 this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3423 if (o != NULL)
3424 {
3425 this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
3426 if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
3427 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
3428 }
3429 }
3430 }
3431 if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
3432 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
3433
3434 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3435 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3436 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3437 create the other. */
3438 if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
3439 {
3440 /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3441 needed. */
3442 if (arg->link_info
3443 /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3444 && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
3445 && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
3446 || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
3447 {
3448 if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
3449 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, name,
3450 false, delay_st_name_p))
3451 {
3452 arg->failed = true;
3453 return;
3454 }
3455 if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
3456 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, name,
3457 true, delay_st_name_p))
3458 {
3459 arg->failed = true;
3460 return;
3461 }
3462 }
3463 else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
3464 (asect->use_rela_p
3465 ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
3466 name,
3467 asect->use_rela_p,
3468 delay_st_name_p))
3469 {
3470 arg->failed = true;
3471 return;
3472 }
3473 }
3474
3475 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3476 sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
3477 if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
3478 && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
3479 {
3480 arg->failed = true;
3481 return;
3482 }
3483
3484 if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
3485 {
3486 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3487 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3488 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3489 }
3490 }
3491
3492 /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3493 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3494 when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3495 from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3496
3497 void
3498 bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
3499 {
3500 bool *failedptr = (bool *) failedptrarg;
3501 asection *elt, *first;
3502 unsigned char *loc;
3503 bool gas;
3504
3505 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3506 elfxx-ia64.c. */
3507 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP
3508 || sec->size == 0
3509 || *failedptr)
3510 return;
3511
3512 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
3513 {
3514 unsigned long symindx = 0;
3515
3516 /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3517 generic linker. */
3518 if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
3519 symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
3520
3521 if (symindx == 0)
3522 {
3523 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3524 elf_section_syms.
3525 PR 25699: A corrupt input file could contain bogus group info. */
3526 if (elf_section_syms (abfd) == NULL)
3527 {
3528 *failedptr = true;
3529 return;
3530 }
3531 symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
3532 }
3533 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
3534 }
3535 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
3536 {
3537 /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3538 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3539 set until all local symbols are output. */
3540 asection *igroup;
3541 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data;
3542 unsigned long symndx;
3543 unsigned long extsymoff;
3544 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3545
3546 /* The point of this little dance to the first SHF_GROUP section
3547 then back to the SHT_GROUP section is that this gets us to
3548 the SHT_GROUP in the input object. */
3549 igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
3550 sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
3551 symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
3552 extsymoff = 0;
3553 if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
3554 {
3555 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3556
3557 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
3558 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3559 }
3560 h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
3561 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3562 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3563 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
3564
3565 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
3566 }
3567
3568 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3569 gas = true;
3570 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3571 {
3572 gas = false;
3573 sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
3574
3575 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3576 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
3577 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3578 {
3579 *failedptr = true;
3580 return;
3581 }
3582 }
3583
3584 loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
3585
3586 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3587 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3588 start of the input section group. */
3589 first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
3590
3591 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3592 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3593 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3594 directives, not that it matters. */
3595 while (elt != NULL)
3596 {
3597 asection *s;
3598
3599 s = elt;
3600 if (!gas)
3601 s = s->output_section;
3602 if (s != NULL
3603 && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
3604 {
3605 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
3606 struct bfd_elf_section_data *input_elf_sec = elf_section_data (elt);
3607
3608 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3609 && (gas
3610 || (input_elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3611 && input_elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3612 {
3613 elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3614 loc -= 4;
3615 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rel.idx, loc);
3616 }
3617 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3618 && (gas
3619 || (input_elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3620 && input_elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3621 {
3622 elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3623 loc -= 4;
3624 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rela.idx, loc);
3625 }
3626 loc -= 4;
3627 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->this_idx, loc);
3628 }
3629 elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
3630 if (elt == first)
3631 break;
3632 }
3633
3634 loc -= 4;
3635 BFD_ASSERT (loc == sec->contents);
3636
3637 H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
3638 }
3639
3640 /* Given NAME, the name of a relocation section stripped of its
3641 .rel/.rela prefix, return the section in ABFD to which the
3642 relocations apply. */
3643
3644 asection *
3645 _bfd_elf_plt_get_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
3646 {
3647 /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3648 section likely apply to .got.plt or .got section. */
3649 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
3650 && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
3651 {
3652 asection *sec;
3653
3654 name = ".got.plt";
3655 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3656 if (sec != NULL)
3657 return sec;
3658 name = ".got";
3659 }
3660
3661 return bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3662 }
3663
3664 /* Return the section to which RELOC_SEC applies. */
3665
3666 static asection *
3667 elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
3668 {
3669 const char *name;
3670 unsigned int type;
3671 bfd *abfd;
3672 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3673
3674 type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
3675 if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
3676 return NULL;
3677
3678 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3679 name = reloc_sec->name;
3680 if (!startswith (name, ".rel"))
3681 return NULL;
3682 name += 4;
3683 if (type == SHT_RELA && *name++ != 'a')
3684 return NULL;
3685
3686 abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
3687 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3688 return bed->get_reloc_section (abfd, name);
3689 }
3690
3691 /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3692 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3693 in here too, while we're at it. LINK_INFO will be 0 when arriving
3694 here for objcopy, and when using the generic ELF linker. */
3695
3696 static bool
3697 assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3698 {
3699 struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
3700 asection *sec;
3701 unsigned int section_number;
3702 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
3703 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
3704 bool need_symtab;
3705 size_t amt;
3706
3707 section_number = 1;
3708
3709 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3710
3711 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3712 if (link_info == NULL || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
3713 {
3714 size_t reloc_count = 0;
3715
3716 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3717 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3718 {
3719 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3720
3721 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
3722 {
3723 if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
3724 {
3725 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3726 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
3727 abfd->section_count--;
3728 }
3729 else
3730 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3731 }
3732
3733 /* Count relocations. */
3734 reloc_count += sec->reloc_count;
3735 }
3736
3737 /* Clear HAS_RELOC if there are no relocations. */
3738 if (reloc_count == 0)
3739 abfd->flags &= ~HAS_RELOC;
3740 }
3741
3742 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3743 {
3744 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3745
3746 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
3747 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3748 if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3749 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
3750 if (d->rel.hdr)
3751 {
3752 d->rel.idx = section_number++;
3753 if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3754 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
3755 }
3756 else
3757 d->rel.idx = 0;
3758
3759 if (d->rela.hdr)
3760 {
3761 d->rela.idx = section_number++;
3762 if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3763 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
3764 }
3765 else
3766 d->rela.idx = 0;
3767 }
3768
3769 need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3770 || (link_info == NULL
3771 && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3772 == HAS_RELOC)));
3773 if (need_symtab)
3774 {
3775 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
3776 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3777 if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
3778 {
3779 elf_section_list *entry;
3780
3781 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) == NULL);
3782
3783 entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
3784 entry->ndx = section_number++;
3785 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
3786 entry->hdr.sh_name
3787 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3788 ".symtab_shndx", false);
3789 if (entry->hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3790 return false;
3791 }
3792 elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3793 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3794 }
3795
3796 elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3797 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
3798 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
3799
3800 if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
3801 {
3802 /* xgettext:c-format */
3803 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: too many sections: %u"),
3804 abfd, section_number);
3805 return false;
3806 }
3807
3808 elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3809 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3810
3811 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3812 indices. */
3813 amt = section_number * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *);
3814 i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3815 if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3816 return false;
3817
3818 i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3819 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3820 if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3821 {
3822 bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3823 return false;
3824 }
3825
3826 elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3827
3828 i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3829 if (need_symtab)
3830 {
3831 i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3832 if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3833 {
3834 elf_section_list * entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
3835 BFD_ASSERT (entry != NULL);
3836 i_shdrp[entry->ndx] = & entry->hdr;
3837 entry->hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3838 }
3839 i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3840 t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
3841 }
3842
3843 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3844 {
3845 asection *s;
3846
3847 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3848
3849 i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3850 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3851 i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3852 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3853 i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3854
3855 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3856
3857 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3858 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3859 the relocation entries apply. */
3860 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3861 {
3862 d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3863 d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3864 d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3865 }
3866 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3867 {
3868 d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3869 d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3870 d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3871 }
3872
3873 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3874 if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3875 {
3876 s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3877 /* We can now have a NULL linked section pointer.
3878 This happens when the sh_link field is 0, which is done
3879 when a linked to section is discarded but the linking
3880 section has been retained for some reason. */
3881 if (s)
3882 {
3883 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3884 if (discarded_section (s))
3885 {
3886 asection *kept;
3887 _bfd_error_handler
3888 /* xgettext:c-format */
3889 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3890 " discarded section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3891 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3892 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3893 size as the discarded one. */
3894 kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3895 if (kept == NULL)
3896 {
3897 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3898 return false;
3899 }
3900 s = kept;
3901 }
3902 /* Handle objcopy. */
3903 else if (s->output_section == NULL)
3904 {
3905 _bfd_error_handler
3906 /* xgettext:c-format */
3907 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3908 " removed section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3909 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3910 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3911 return false;
3912 }
3913 s = s->output_section;
3914 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3915 }
3916 }
3917
3918 switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3919 {
3920 case SHT_REL:
3921 case SHT_RELA:
3922 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3923 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3924 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3925 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3926 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3927 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3928 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3929 if (s != NULL)
3930 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3931
3932 s = elf_get_reloc_section (sec);
3933 if (s != NULL)
3934 {
3935 d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3936 d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3937 }
3938 break;
3939
3940 case SHT_STRTAB:
3941 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3942 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3943 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3944 field to point to this section. */
3945 if (startswith (sec->name, ".stab")
3946 && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3947 {
3948 size_t len;
3949 char *alc;
3950
3951 len = strlen (sec->name);
3952 alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3953 if (alc == NULL)
3954 return false;
3955 memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3956 alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3957 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3958 free (alc);
3959 if (s != NULL)
3960 {
3961 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3962
3963 /* This is a .stab section. */
3964 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 12;
3965 }
3966 }
3967 break;
3968
3969 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3970 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3971 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3972 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3973 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3974 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3975 version strings. */
3976 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3977 if (s != NULL)
3978 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3979 break;
3980
3981 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3982 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3983 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3984 the version strings. */
3985 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3986 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3987 if (s != NULL)
3988 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3989 break;
3990
3991 case SHT_HASH:
3992 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3993 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3994 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3995 this hash table or version table is for. */
3996 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3997 if (s != NULL)
3998 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3999 break;
4000
4001 case SHT_GROUP:
4002 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
4003 }
4004 }
4005
4006 /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
4007 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
4008 debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
4009
4010 return true;
4011 }
4012
4013 static bool
4014 sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
4015 {
4016 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
4017 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4018 if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
4019 return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
4020
4021 return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
4022 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_asymbol_section (sym))
4023 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_asymbol_section (sym)));
4024 }
4025
4026 /* Filter global symbols of ABFD to include in the import library. All
4027 SYMCOUNT symbols of ABFD can be examined from their pointers in
4028 SYMS. Pointers of symbols to keep should be stored contiguously at
4029 the beginning of that array.
4030
4031 Returns the number of symbols to keep. */
4032
4033 unsigned int
4034 _bfd_elf_filter_global_symbols (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4035 asymbol **syms, long symcount)
4036 {
4037 long src_count, dst_count = 0;
4038
4039 for (src_count = 0; src_count < symcount; src_count++)
4040 {
4041 asymbol *sym = syms[src_count];
4042 char *name = (char *) bfd_asymbol_name (sym);
4043 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
4044
4045 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4046 continue;
4047
4048 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, name, false, false, false);
4049 if (h == NULL)
4050 continue;
4051 if (h->type != bfd_link_hash_defined && h->type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4052 continue;
4053 if (h->linker_def || h->ldscript_def)
4054 continue;
4055
4056 syms[dst_count++] = sym;
4057 }
4058
4059 syms[dst_count] = NULL;
4060
4061 return dst_count;
4062 }
4063
4064 /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
4065 output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
4066
4067 static bool
4068 ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
4069 {
4070 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
4071
4072 if (sym == NULL)
4073 return false;
4074
4075 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
4076 return false;
4077
4078 /* Ignore the section symbol if it isn't used. */
4079 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM_USED) == 0)
4080 return true;
4081
4082 if (sym->section == NULL)
4083 return true;
4084
4085 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (sym);
4086 return ((type_ptr != NULL
4087 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
4088 && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4089 || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
4090 || (sym->section->output_section != NULL
4091 && sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
4092 && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
4093 || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
4094 }
4095
4096 /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
4097 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
4098
4099 static bool
4100 elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
4101 {
4102 unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
4103 asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
4104 asymbol **sect_syms;
4105 unsigned int num_locals = 0;
4106 unsigned int num_globals = 0;
4107 unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
4108 unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
4109 unsigned int max_index = 0;
4110 unsigned int idx;
4111 asection *asect;
4112 asymbol **new_syms;
4113 size_t amt;
4114
4115 #ifdef DEBUG
4116 fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
4117 fflush (stderr);
4118 #endif
4119
4120 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4121 {
4122 if (max_index < asect->index)
4123 max_index = asect->index;
4124 }
4125
4126 max_index++;
4127 amt = max_index * sizeof (asymbol *);
4128 sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4129 if (sect_syms == NULL)
4130 return false;
4131 elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
4132 elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
4133
4134 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
4135 decided to output. */
4136 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4137 {
4138 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4139
4140 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
4141 && sym->value == 0
4142 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4143 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4144 {
4145 asection *sec = sym->section;
4146
4147 if (sec->owner != abfd)
4148 sec = sec->output_section;
4149
4150 sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
4151 }
4152 }
4153
4154 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
4155 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4156 {
4157 if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
4158 num_globals++;
4159 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
4160 num_locals++;
4161 }
4162
4163 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
4164 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
4165 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
4166 at least in that case. */
4167 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4168 {
4169 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
4170 /* Don't include ignored section symbols. */
4171 if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4172 && sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4173 {
4174 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
4175 num_locals++;
4176 else
4177 num_globals++;
4178 }
4179 }
4180
4181 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
4182 amt = (num_locals + num_globals) * sizeof (asymbol *);
4183 new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4184 if (new_syms == NULL)
4185 return false;
4186
4187 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4188 {
4189 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4190 unsigned int i;
4191
4192 if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4193 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4194 /* Don't include ignored section symbols. */
4195 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
4196 i = num_locals2++;
4197 else
4198 continue;
4199 new_syms[i] = sym;
4200 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4201 }
4202 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4203 {
4204 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
4205 if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4206 && sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4207 {
4208 unsigned int i;
4209
4210 sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
4211 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4212 i = num_locals2++;
4213 else
4214 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4215 new_syms[i] = sym;
4216 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4217 }
4218 }
4219
4220 bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
4221
4222 *pnum_locals = num_locals;
4223 return true;
4224 }
4225
4226 /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
4227 ELF data structure. */
4228
4229 static inline file_ptr
4230 align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
4231 {
4232 return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
4233 }
4234
4235 /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
4236 required section alignment. */
4237
4238 file_ptr
4239 _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
4240 file_ptr offset,
4241 bool align)
4242 {
4243 if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
4244 offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
4245 i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
4246 if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
4247 i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
4248 if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4249 offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
4250 return offset;
4251 }
4252
4253 /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
4254 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
4255 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
4256
4257 bool
4258 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
4259 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4260 {
4261 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4262 struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
4263 bool failed;
4264 struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
4265 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
4266 bool need_symtab;
4267
4268 if (abfd->output_has_begun)
4269 return true;
4270
4271 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
4272 if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
4273 (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
4274
4275 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_init_file_header) (abfd, link_info))
4276 return false;
4277
4278 fsargs.failed = false;
4279 fsargs.link_info = link_info;
4280 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
4281 if (fsargs.failed)
4282 return false;
4283
4284 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
4285 return false;
4286
4287 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
4288 need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
4289 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
4290 || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
4291 == HAS_RELOC)));
4292 if (need_symtab)
4293 {
4294 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
4295 int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
4296
4297 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p, link_info))
4298 return false;
4299 }
4300
4301 failed = false;
4302 if (link_info == NULL)
4303 {
4304 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
4305 if (failed)
4306 return false;
4307 }
4308
4309 shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
4310 /* sh_name was set in init_file_header. */
4311 shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
4312 shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
4313 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
4314 /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4315 shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
4316 shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
4317 shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
4318 /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4319 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
4320
4321 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
4322 return false;
4323
4324 if (need_symtab)
4325 {
4326 file_ptr off;
4327 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4328
4329 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
4330
4331 hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4332 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, true);
4333
4334 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL)
4335 {
4336 hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
4337 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
4338 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, true);
4339 /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ? */
4340 }
4341
4342 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
4343 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, true);
4344
4345 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
4346
4347 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
4348 out. */
4349 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
4350 || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
4351 return false;
4352 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
4353 }
4354
4355 abfd->output_has_begun = true;
4356
4357 return true;
4358 }
4359
4360 /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
4361 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
4362
4363 static bfd_size_type
4364 get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4365 {
4366 size_t segs;
4367 asection *s;
4368 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4369
4370 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
4371 and one for data. */
4372 segs = 2;
4373
4374 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4375 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0 && s->size != 0)
4376 {
4377 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
4378 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
4379 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
4380 targets. */
4381 segs += 2;
4382 }
4383
4384 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
4385 {
4386 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4387 ++segs;
4388 }
4389
4390 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4391 {
4392 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
4393 ++segs;
4394 }
4395
4396 if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
4397 {
4398 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
4399 ++segs;
4400 }
4401
4402 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4403 {
4404 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
4405 ++segs;
4406 }
4407
4408 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
4409 NOTE_GNU_PROPERTY_SECTION_NAME);
4410 if (s != NULL && s->size != 0)
4411 {
4412 /* We need a PT_GNU_PROPERTY segment. */
4413 ++segs;
4414 }
4415
4416 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4417 {
4418 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4419 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE)
4420 {
4421 unsigned int alignment_power;
4422 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
4423 ++segs;
4424 /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment for all adjacent
4425 loadable SHT_NOTE sections. gABI requires that within a
4426 PT_NOTE segment (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
4427 each note should have the same alignment. So we check
4428 whether the sections are correctly aligned. */
4429 alignment_power = s->alignment_power;
4430 while (s->next != NULL
4431 && s->next->alignment_power == alignment_power
4432 && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4433 && elf_section_type (s->next) == SHT_NOTE)
4434 s = s->next;
4435 }
4436 }
4437
4438 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4439 {
4440 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4441 {
4442 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
4443 ++segs;
4444 break;
4445 }
4446 }
4447
4448 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4449
4450 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4451 && (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind) != 0)
4452 {
4453 /* Add a PT_GNU_MBIND segment for each mbind section. */
4454 bfd_vma commonpagesize;
4455 unsigned int page_align_power;
4456
4457 if (info != NULL)
4458 commonpagesize = info->commonpagesize;
4459 else
4460 commonpagesize = bed->commonpagesize;
4461 page_align_power = bfd_log2 (commonpagesize);
4462 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4463 if (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
4464 {
4465 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info > PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM)
4466 {
4467 _bfd_error_handler
4468 /* xgettext:c-format */
4469 (_("%pB: GNU_MBIND section `%pA' has invalid "
4470 "sh_info field: %d"),
4471 abfd, s, elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4472 continue;
4473 }
4474 /* Align mbind section to page size. */
4475 if (s->alignment_power < page_align_power)
4476 s->alignment_power = page_align_power;
4477 segs ++;
4478 }
4479 }
4480
4481 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
4482 if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
4483 {
4484 int a;
4485
4486 a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
4487 if (a == -1)
4488 abort ();
4489 segs += a;
4490 }
4491
4492 return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4493 }
4494
4495 /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
4496
4497 Elf_Internal_Phdr *
4498 _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
4499 {
4500 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4501 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4502
4503 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4504 m != NULL;
4505 m = m->next, p++)
4506 {
4507 int i;
4508
4509 for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4510 if (m->sections[i] == section)
4511 return p;
4512 }
4513
4514 return NULL;
4515 }
4516
4517 /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4518
4519 static struct elf_segment_map *
4520 make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
4521 asection **sections,
4522 unsigned int from,
4523 unsigned int to,
4524 bool phdr)
4525 {
4526 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4527 unsigned int i;
4528 asection **hdrpp;
4529 size_t amt;
4530
4531 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
4532 amt += (to - from) * sizeof (asection *);
4533 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4534 if (m == NULL)
4535 return NULL;
4536 m->next = NULL;
4537 m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
4538 for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
4539 m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
4540 m->count = to - from;
4541
4542 if (from == 0 && phdr)
4543 {
4544 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4545 m->includes_filehdr = 1;
4546 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4547 }
4548
4549 return m;
4550 }
4551
4552 /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4553 on failure. */
4554
4555 struct elf_segment_map *
4556 _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
4557 {
4558 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4559
4560 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
4561 sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
4562 if (m == NULL)
4563 return NULL;
4564 m->next = NULL;
4565 m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
4566 m->count = 1;
4567 m->sections[0] = dynsec;
4568
4569 return m;
4570 }
4571
4572 /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4573
4574 static bool
4575 elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
4576 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4577 bool remove_empty_load)
4578 {
4579 struct elf_segment_map **m;
4580 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4581
4582 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4583 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4584 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4585 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4586 removed. */
4587 m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
4588 while (*m)
4589 {
4590 unsigned int i, new_count;
4591
4592 for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
4593 {
4594 if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
4595 && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
4596 || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
4597 {
4598 (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
4599 new_count++;
4600 }
4601 }
4602 (*m)->count = new_count;
4603
4604 if (remove_empty_load
4605 && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD
4606 && (*m)->count == 0
4607 && !(*m)->includes_phdrs)
4608 *m = (*m)->next;
4609 else
4610 m = &(*m)->next;
4611 }
4612
4613 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4614 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
4615 {
4616 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
4617 return false;
4618 }
4619
4620 return true;
4621 }
4622
4623 #define IS_TBSS(s) \
4624 ((s->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) == SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4625
4626 /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4627
4628 bool
4629 _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4630 {
4631 unsigned int count;
4632 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4633 asection **sections = NULL;
4634 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4635 bool no_user_phdrs;
4636
4637 no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
4638
4639 if (info != NULL)
4640 info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
4641
4642 if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
4643 {
4644 asection *s;
4645 unsigned int i;
4646 struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
4647 struct elf_segment_map **pm;
4648 asection *last_hdr;
4649 bfd_vma last_size;
4650 unsigned int hdr_index;
4651 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
4652 asection **hdrpp;
4653 bool phdr_in_segment;
4654 bool writable;
4655 bool executable;
4656 unsigned int tls_count = 0;
4657 asection *first_tls = NULL;
4658 asection *first_mbind = NULL;
4659 asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
4660 size_t amt;
4661 bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0; /* Bytes. */
4662 bfd_size_type phdr_size; /* Octets/bytes. */
4663 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
4664
4665 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4666
4667 amt = bfd_count_sections (abfd) * sizeof (asection *);
4668 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc (amt);
4669 if (sections == NULL)
4670 goto error_return;
4671
4672 /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4673 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4674 being shifted. */
4675 addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
4676 addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
4677
4678 i = 0;
4679 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4680 {
4681 if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4682 {
4683 /* target_index is unused until bfd_elf_final_link
4684 starts output of section symbols. Use it to make
4685 qsort stable. */
4686 s->target_index = i;
4687 sections[i] = s;
4688 ++i;
4689 /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4690 if (((s->lma + s->size / opb) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
4691 wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size / opb) & addr_mask;
4692 }
4693 }
4694 BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
4695 count = i;
4696
4697 qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
4698
4699 phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
4700 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4701 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
4702 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4703 /* phdr_size is compared to LMA values which are in bytes. */
4704 phdr_size /= opb;
4705 if (info != NULL)
4706 maxpagesize = info->maxpagesize;
4707 else
4708 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4709 if (maxpagesize == 0)
4710 maxpagesize = 1;
4711 phdr_in_segment = info != NULL && info->load_phdrs;
4712 if (count != 0
4713 && (((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) & (maxpagesize - 1))
4714 >= (phdr_size & (maxpagesize - 1))))
4715 /* For compatibility with old scripts that may not be using
4716 SIZEOF_HEADERS, add headers when it looks like space has
4717 been left for them. */
4718 phdr_in_segment = true;
4719
4720 /* Build the mapping. */
4721 mfirst = NULL;
4722 pm = &mfirst;
4723
4724 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4725 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4726 section. */
4727 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4728 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0 && s->size != 0)
4729 {
4730 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4731 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4732 if (m == NULL)
4733 goto error_return;
4734 m->next = NULL;
4735 m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
4736 m->p_flags = PF_R;
4737 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4738 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4739 phdr_in_segment = true;
4740 *pm = m;
4741 pm = &m->next;
4742
4743 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4744 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4745 if (m == NULL)
4746 goto error_return;
4747 m->next = NULL;
4748 m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
4749 m->count = 1;
4750 m->sections[0] = s;
4751
4752 *pm = m;
4753 pm = &m->next;
4754 }
4755
4756 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4757 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4758 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4759 last_hdr = NULL;
4760 last_size = 0;
4761 hdr_index = 0;
4762 writable = false;
4763 executable = false;
4764 dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4765 if (dynsec != NULL
4766 && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
4767 dynsec = NULL;
4768
4769 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4770 phdr_in_segment = false;
4771
4772 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4773 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4774 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4775 program headers we will need. */
4776 if (phdr_in_segment && count > 0)
4777 {
4778 bfd_vma phdr_lma; /* Bytes. */
4779 bool separate_phdr = false;
4780
4781 phdr_lma = (sections[0]->lma - phdr_size) & addr_mask & -maxpagesize;
4782 if (info != NULL
4783 && info->separate_code
4784 && (sections[0]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4785 {
4786 /* If data sections should be separate from code and
4787 thus not executable, and the first section is
4788 executable then put the file and program headers in
4789 their own PT_LOAD. */
4790 separate_phdr = true;
4791 if ((((phdr_lma + phdr_size - 1) & addr_mask & -maxpagesize)
4792 == (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize)))
4793 {
4794 /* The file and program headers are currently on the
4795 same page as the first section. Put them on the
4796 previous page if we can. */
4797 if (phdr_lma >= maxpagesize)
4798 phdr_lma -= maxpagesize;
4799 else
4800 separate_phdr = false;
4801 }
4802 }
4803 if ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_lma
4804 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size)
4805 /* If file and program headers would be placed at the end
4806 of memory then it's probably better to omit them. */
4807 phdr_in_segment = false;
4808 else if (phdr_lma < wrap_to)
4809 /* If a section wraps around to where we'll be placing
4810 file and program headers, then the headers will be
4811 overwritten. */
4812 phdr_in_segment = false;
4813 else if (separate_phdr)
4814 {
4815 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, 0, 0, phdr_in_segment);
4816 if (m == NULL)
4817 goto error_return;
4818 m->p_paddr = phdr_lma * opb;
4819 m->p_vaddr_offset
4820 = (sections[0]->vma - phdr_size) & addr_mask & -maxpagesize;
4821 m->p_paddr_valid = 1;
4822 *pm = m;
4823 pm = &m->next;
4824 phdr_in_segment = false;
4825 }
4826 }
4827
4828 for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
4829 {
4830 asection *hdr;
4831 bool new_segment;
4832
4833 hdr = *hdrpp;
4834
4835 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4836 segment. */
4837
4838 if (last_hdr == NULL)
4839 {
4840 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4841 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4842 new_segment = false;
4843 }
4844 else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
4845 {
4846 /* If this section has a different relation between the
4847 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4848 segment. */
4849 new_segment = true;
4850 }
4851 else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
4852 || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
4853 {
4854 /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4855 the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4856 new_segment = true;
4857 }
4858 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4859 && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4860 == (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
4861 {
4862 /* If we are demand paged then we can't map two disk
4863 pages onto the same memory page. */
4864 new_segment = false;
4865 }
4866 /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4867 to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4868 around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4869 pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4870 section can be included in the current segment. */
4871 else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4872 + maxpagesize > last_hdr->lma)
4873 && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4874 + maxpagesize <= hdr->lma))
4875 {
4876 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4877 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4878 new_segment = true;
4879 }
4880 else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
4881 && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
4882 {
4883 /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4884 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4885 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4886 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose. */
4887 new_segment = true;
4888 }
4889 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4890 {
4891 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4892 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4893 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4894 new_segment = false;
4895 }
4896 else if (info != NULL
4897 && info->separate_code
4898 && executable != ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0))
4899 {
4900 new_segment = true;
4901 }
4902 else if (! writable
4903 && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4904 {
4905 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4906 segment. */
4907 new_segment = true;
4908 }
4909 else
4910 {
4911 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4912 new_segment = false;
4913 }
4914
4915 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4916 if (last_hdr != NULL
4917 && info != NULL
4918 && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
4919 new_segment
4920 = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
4921 last_hdr,
4922 new_segment);
4923
4924 if (! new_segment)
4925 {
4926 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4927 writable = true;
4928 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4929 executable = true;
4930 last_hdr = hdr;
4931 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4932 last_size = (!IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0) / opb;
4933 continue;
4934 }
4935
4936 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4937 header holding all the sections from hdr_index until hdr. */
4938
4939 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, hdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4940 if (m == NULL)
4941 goto error_return;
4942
4943 *pm = m;
4944 pm = &m->next;
4945
4946 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4947 writable = true;
4948 else
4949 writable = false;
4950
4951 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
4952 executable = false;
4953 else
4954 executable = true;
4955
4956 last_hdr = hdr;
4957 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4958 last_size = (!IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0) / opb;
4959 hdr_index = i;
4960 phdr_in_segment = false;
4961 }
4962
4963 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4964 for .tbss. */
4965 if (last_hdr != NULL
4966 && (i - hdr_index != 1
4967 || !IS_TBSS (last_hdr)))
4968 {
4969 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, hdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4970 if (m == NULL)
4971 goto error_return;
4972
4973 *pm = m;
4974 pm = &m->next;
4975 }
4976
4977 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4978 if (dynsec != NULL)
4979 {
4980 m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4981 if (m == NULL)
4982 goto error_return;
4983 *pm = m;
4984 pm = &m->next;
4985 }
4986
4987 /* For each batch of consecutive loadable SHT_NOTE sections,
4988 add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4989 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4990 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4991 in the output file. */
4992 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4993 {
4994 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4995 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE)
4996 {
4997 asection *s2;
4998 unsigned int alignment_power = s->alignment_power;
4999
5000 count = 1;
5001 for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
5002 {
5003 if (s2->next->alignment_power == alignment_power
5004 && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
5005 && elf_section_type (s2->next) == SHT_NOTE
5006 && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size / opb,
5007 alignment_power)
5008 == s2->next->lma)
5009 count++;
5010 else
5011 break;
5012 }
5013 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
5014 amt += count * sizeof (asection *);
5015 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5016 if (m == NULL)
5017 goto error_return;
5018 m->next = NULL;
5019 m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
5020 m->count = count;
5021 while (count > 1)
5022 {
5023 m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
5024 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
5025 s = s->next;
5026 }
5027 m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
5028 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
5029 *pm = m;
5030 pm = &m->next;
5031 }
5032 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
5033 {
5034 if (! tls_count)
5035 first_tls = s;
5036 tls_count++;
5037 }
5038 if (first_mbind == NULL
5039 && (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
5040 first_mbind = s;
5041 }
5042
5043 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
5044 if (tls_count > 0)
5045 {
5046 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
5047 amt += tls_count * sizeof (asection *);
5048 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5049 if (m == NULL)
5050 goto error_return;
5051 m->next = NULL;
5052 m->p_type = PT_TLS;
5053 m->count = tls_count;
5054 /* Mandated PF_R. */
5055 m->p_flags = PF_R;
5056 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5057 s = first_tls;
5058 for (i = 0; i < tls_count; ++i)
5059 {
5060 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
5061 {
5062 _bfd_error_handler
5063 (_("%pB: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
5064 s = first_tls;
5065 i = 0;
5066 while (i < tls_count)
5067 {
5068 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
5069 {
5070 _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %pA"), s);
5071 i++;
5072 }
5073 else
5074 _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %pA"), s);
5075 s = s->next;
5076 }
5077 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5078 goto error_return;
5079 }
5080 m->sections[i] = s;
5081 s = s->next;
5082 }
5083
5084 *pm = m;
5085 pm = &m->next;
5086 }
5087
5088 if (first_mbind
5089 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
5090 && (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind) != 0)
5091 for (s = first_mbind; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5092 if ((elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0
5093 && elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info <= PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM)
5094 {
5095 /* Mandated PF_R. */
5096 unsigned long p_flags = PF_R;
5097 if ((s->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
5098 p_flags |= PF_W;
5099 if ((s->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
5100 p_flags |= PF_X;
5101
5102 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
5103 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5104 if (m == NULL)
5105 goto error_return;
5106 m->next = NULL;
5107 m->p_type = (PT_GNU_MBIND_LO
5108 + elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
5109 m->count = 1;
5110 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5111 m->sections[0] = s;
5112 m->p_flags = p_flags;
5113
5114 *pm = m;
5115 pm = &m->next;
5116 }
5117
5118 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
5119 NOTE_GNU_PROPERTY_SECTION_NAME);
5120 if (s != NULL && s->size != 0)
5121 {
5122 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
5123 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5124 if (m == NULL)
5125 goto error_return;
5126 m->next = NULL;
5127 m->p_type = PT_GNU_PROPERTY;
5128 m->count = 1;
5129 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5130 m->sections[0] = s;
5131 m->p_flags = PF_R;
5132 *pm = m;
5133 pm = &m->next;
5134 }
5135
5136 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
5137 segment. */
5138 eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
5139 if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
5140 && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
5141 {
5142 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5143 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5144 if (m == NULL)
5145 goto error_return;
5146 m->next = NULL;
5147 m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
5148 m->count = 1;
5149 m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
5150
5151 *pm = m;
5152 pm = &m->next;
5153 }
5154
5155 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
5156 {
5157 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5158 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5159 if (m == NULL)
5160 goto error_return;
5161 m->next = NULL;
5162 m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
5163 m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
5164 m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
5165 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5166 m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
5167 if (info->stacksize > 0)
5168 {
5169 m->p_size = info->stacksize;
5170 m->p_size_valid = 1;
5171 }
5172
5173 *pm = m;
5174 pm = &m->next;
5175 }
5176
5177 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
5178 {
5179 for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
5180 {
5181 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
5182 && m->count != 0
5183 && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
5184 && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
5185 {
5186 i = m->count;
5187 while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
5188 {
5189 if (m->sections[i]->size > 0
5190 && (m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5191 == (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5192 break;
5193 }
5194
5195 if (i != (unsigned) -1)
5196 break;
5197 }
5198 }
5199
5200 /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
5201 if (m != NULL)
5202 {
5203 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5204 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5205 if (m == NULL)
5206 goto error_return;
5207 m->next = NULL;
5208 m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
5209 *pm = m;
5210 pm = &m->next;
5211 }
5212 }
5213
5214 free (sections);
5215 elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
5216 }
5217
5218 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
5219 return false;
5220
5221 for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5222 ++count;
5223 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5224
5225 return true;
5226
5227 error_return:
5228 free (sections);
5229 return false;
5230 }
5231
5232 /* Sort sections by address. */
5233
5234 static int
5235 elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5236 {
5237 const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
5238 const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
5239 bfd_size_type size1, size2;
5240
5241 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
5242 place the section into a segment. */
5243 if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
5244 return -1;
5245 else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
5246 return 1;
5247
5248 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
5249 the same, and this will do nothing. */
5250 if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
5251 return -1;
5252 else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
5253 return 1;
5254
5255 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
5256
5257 #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0 \
5258 && (x)->size != 0)
5259
5260 if (TOEND (sec1))
5261 {
5262 if (!TOEND (sec2))
5263 return 1;
5264 }
5265 else if (TOEND (sec2))
5266 return -1;
5267
5268 #undef TOEND
5269
5270 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
5271 before others at the same address. */
5272
5273 size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
5274 size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
5275
5276 if (size1 < size2)
5277 return -1;
5278 if (size1 > size2)
5279 return 1;
5280
5281 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5282 }
5283
5284 /* This qsort comparison functions sorts PT_LOAD segments first and
5285 by p_paddr, for assign_file_positions_for_load_sections. */
5286
5287 static int
5288 elf_sort_segments (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5289 {
5290 const struct elf_segment_map *m1 = *(const struct elf_segment_map **) arg1;
5291 const struct elf_segment_map *m2 = *(const struct elf_segment_map **) arg2;
5292
5293 if (m1->p_type != m2->p_type)
5294 {
5295 if (m1->p_type == PT_NULL)
5296 return 1;
5297 if (m2->p_type == PT_NULL)
5298 return -1;
5299 return m1->p_type < m2->p_type ? -1 : 1;
5300 }
5301 if (m1->includes_filehdr != m2->includes_filehdr)
5302 return m1->includes_filehdr ? -1 : 1;
5303 if (m1->no_sort_lma != m2->no_sort_lma)
5304 return m1->no_sort_lma ? -1 : 1;
5305 if (m1->p_type == PT_LOAD && !m1->no_sort_lma)
5306 {
5307 bfd_vma lma1, lma2; /* Octets. */
5308 lma1 = 0;
5309 if (m1->p_paddr_valid)
5310 lma1 = m1->p_paddr;
5311 else if (m1->count != 0)
5312 {
5313 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (m1->sections[0]->owner,
5314 m1->sections[0]);
5315 lma1 = (m1->sections[0]->lma + m1->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5316 }
5317 lma2 = 0;
5318 if (m2->p_paddr_valid)
5319 lma2 = m2->p_paddr;
5320 else if (m2->count != 0)
5321 {
5322 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (m2->sections[0]->owner,
5323 m2->sections[0]);
5324 lma2 = (m2->sections[0]->lma + m2->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5325 }
5326 if (lma1 != lma2)
5327 return lma1 < lma2 ? -1 : 1;
5328 }
5329 if (m1->idx != m2->idx)
5330 return m1->idx < m2->idx ? -1 : 1;
5331 return 0;
5332 }
5333
5334 /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
5335
5336 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
5337 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
5338 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
5339 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
5340 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
5341 which is wrong.
5342
5343 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
5344 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
5345 the page size.'' */
5346 /* In other words, something like:
5347
5348 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
5349 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
5350 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
5351 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
5352 else
5353 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
5354
5355 which can be collapsed into the expression below. */
5356
5357 static file_ptr
5358 vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
5359 {
5360 /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
5361 if (maxpagesize == 0)
5362 maxpagesize = 1;
5363 return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
5364 }
5365
5366 static void
5367 print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
5368 {
5369 unsigned int j;
5370 const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
5371 char buf[32];
5372
5373 if (pt == NULL)
5374 {
5375 if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
5376 sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
5377 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
5378 else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
5379 sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
5380 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
5381 else
5382 snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
5383 (unsigned int) m->p_type);
5384 pt = buf;
5385 }
5386 fflush (stdout);
5387 fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
5388 for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
5389 fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
5390 putc ('\n',stderr);
5391 fflush (stderr);
5392 }
5393
5394 static bool
5395 write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
5396 {
5397 void *buf;
5398 bool ret;
5399
5400 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
5401 return false;
5402 buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
5403 if (buf == NULL)
5404 return false;
5405 ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
5406 free (buf);
5407 return ret;
5408 }
5409
5410 /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
5411 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
5412 the file header. */
5413
5414 static bool
5415 assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5416 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5417 {
5418 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5419 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5420 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_load_seg;
5421 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5422 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5423 file_ptr off; /* Octets. */
5424 bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
5425 unsigned int alloc, actual;
5426 unsigned int i, j;
5427 struct elf_segment_map **sorted_seg_map;
5428 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
5429
5430 if (link_info == NULL
5431 && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
5432 return false;
5433
5434 alloc = 0;
5435 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5436 m->idx = alloc++;
5437
5438 if (alloc)
5439 {
5440 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5441 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5442 }
5443 else
5444 {
5445 /* PR binutils/12467. */
5446 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
5447 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
5448 }
5449
5450 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
5451
5452 if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
5453 {
5454 actual = alloc;
5455 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5456 }
5457 else
5458 {
5459 actual = elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5460 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
5461 == actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
5462 BFD_ASSERT (actual >= alloc);
5463 }
5464
5465 if (alloc == 0)
5466 {
5467 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5468 return true;
5469 }
5470
5471 /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
5472 see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
5473 that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
5474 The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
5475 elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
5476 layout.
5477 See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
5478 where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
5479 last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
5480 phdrs = bfd_zalloc (abfd, (actual * sizeof (*phdrs)
5481 + alloc * sizeof (*sorted_seg_map)));
5482 sorted_seg_map = (struct elf_segment_map **) (phdrs + actual);
5483 elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
5484 if (phdrs == NULL)
5485 return false;
5486
5487 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), j = 0; m != NULL; m = m->next, j++)
5488 {
5489 sorted_seg_map[j] = m;
5490 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
5491 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
5492 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
5493 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
5494 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
5495 if (m->count > 1
5496 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
5497 && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
5498 {
5499 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5500 m->sections[i]->target_index = i;
5501 qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
5502 elf_sort_sections);
5503 }
5504 }
5505 if (alloc > 1)
5506 qsort (sorted_seg_map, alloc, sizeof (*sorted_seg_map),
5507 elf_sort_segments);
5508
5509 maxpagesize = 1;
5510 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5511 {
5512 if (link_info != NULL)
5513 maxpagesize = link_info->maxpagesize;
5514 else
5515 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
5516 }
5517
5518 /* Sections must map to file offsets past the ELF file header. */
5519 off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5520 /* And if one of the PT_LOAD headers doesn't include the program
5521 headers then we'll be mapping program headers in the usual
5522 position after the ELF file header. */
5523 phdr_load_seg = NULL;
5524 for (j = 0; j < alloc; j++)
5525 {
5526 m = sorted_seg_map[j];
5527 if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5528 break;
5529 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5530 {
5531 phdr_load_seg = m;
5532 break;
5533 }
5534 }
5535 if (phdr_load_seg == NULL)
5536 off += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5537
5538 for (j = 0; j < alloc; j++)
5539 {
5540 asection **secpp;
5541 bfd_vma off_adjust; /* Octets. */
5542 bool no_contents;
5543
5544 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
5545 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
5546 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
5547 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
5548 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
5549 m = sorted_seg_map[j];
5550 p = phdrs + m->idx;
5551 p->p_type = m->p_type;
5552 p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
5553
5554 if (m->count == 0)
5555 p->p_vaddr = m->p_vaddr_offset * opb;
5556 else
5557 p->p_vaddr = (m->sections[0]->vma + m->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5558
5559 if (m->p_paddr_valid)
5560 p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
5561 else if (m->count == 0)
5562 p->p_paddr = 0;
5563 else
5564 p->p_paddr = (m->sections[0]->lma + m->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5565
5566 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5567 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5568 {
5569 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
5570 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
5571 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
5572 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
5573 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
5574 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
5575 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
5576 segment. */
5577 if (m->p_align_valid)
5578 maxpagesize = m->p_align;
5579
5580 p->p_align = maxpagesize;
5581 }
5582 else if (m->p_align_valid)
5583 p->p_align = m->p_align;
5584 else if (m->count == 0)
5585 p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
5586
5587 if (m == phdr_load_seg)
5588 {
5589 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5590 p->p_offset = off;
5591 off += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5592 }
5593
5594 no_contents = false;
5595 off_adjust = 0;
5596 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5597 && m->count > 0)
5598 {
5599 bfd_size_type align; /* Bytes. */
5600 unsigned int align_power = 0;
5601
5602 if (m->p_align_valid)
5603 align = p->p_align;
5604 else
5605 {
5606 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5607 {
5608 unsigned int secalign;
5609
5610 secalign = bfd_section_alignment (*secpp);
5611 if (secalign > align_power)
5612 align_power = secalign;
5613 }
5614 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
5615 if (align < maxpagesize)
5616 align = maxpagesize;
5617 }
5618
5619 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5620 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
5621 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
5622 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
5623 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
5624 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
5625
5626 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
5627 sections. */
5628 no_contents = true;
5629 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5630 if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
5631 {
5632 no_contents = false;
5633 break;
5634 }
5635
5636 off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align * opb);
5637
5638 /* Broken hardware and/or kernel require that files do not
5639 map the same page with different permissions on some hppa
5640 processors. */
5641 if (j != 0
5642 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
5643 && bed->no_page_alias
5644 && (off & (maxpagesize - 1)) != 0
5645 && ((off & -maxpagesize)
5646 == ((off + off_adjust) & -maxpagesize)))
5647 off_adjust += maxpagesize;
5648 off += off_adjust;
5649 if (no_contents)
5650 {
5651 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
5652 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
5653 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
5654 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
5655 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
5656 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
5657 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
5658 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
5659 }
5660 else
5661 off_adjust = 0;
5662 }
5663 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
5664 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
5665 else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
5666 && m->count > 1
5667 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
5668 {
5669 _bfd_error_handler
5670 (_("%pB: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment"
5671 " is not the .dynamic section"),
5672 abfd);
5673 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5674 return false;
5675 }
5676 /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
5677 else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
5678 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5679 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
5680
5681 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5682 {
5683 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5684 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5685 p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5686 p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5687 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5688 {
5689 if (m->count > 0)
5690 {
5691 if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off
5692 || (!m->p_paddr_valid
5693 && p->p_paddr < (bfd_vma) off))
5694 {
5695 _bfd_error_handler
5696 (_("%pB: not enough room for program headers,"
5697 " try linking with -N"),
5698 abfd);
5699 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5700 return false;
5701 }
5702 p->p_vaddr -= off;
5703 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5704 p->p_paddr -= off;
5705 }
5706 }
5707 else if (sorted_seg_map[0]->includes_filehdr)
5708 {
5709 Elf_Internal_Phdr *filehdr = phdrs + sorted_seg_map[0]->idx;
5710 p->p_vaddr = filehdr->p_vaddr;
5711 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5712 p->p_paddr = filehdr->p_paddr;
5713 }
5714 }
5715
5716 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5717 {
5718 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5719 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5720 p->p_filesz += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5721 p->p_memsz += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5722 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5723 {
5724 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5725 {
5726 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = p->p_offset;
5727 if (m->count > 0)
5728 {
5729 p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5730 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5731 p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5732 }
5733 }
5734 else if (phdr_load_seg != NULL)
5735 {
5736 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr = phdrs + phdr_load_seg->idx;
5737 bfd_vma phdr_off = 0; /* Octets. */
5738 if (phdr_load_seg->includes_filehdr)
5739 phdr_off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5740 p->p_vaddr = phdr->p_vaddr + phdr_off;
5741 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5742 p->p_paddr = phdr->p_paddr + phdr_off;
5743 p->p_offset = phdr->p_offset + phdr_off;
5744 }
5745 else
5746 p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5747 }
5748 }
5749
5750 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5751 || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
5752 {
5753 if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
5754 {
5755 p->p_offset = off;
5756 if (no_contents)
5757 {
5758 /* Put meaningless p_offset for PT_LOAD segments
5759 without file contents somewhere within the first
5760 page, in an attempt to not point past EOF. */
5761 bfd_size_type align = maxpagesize;
5762 if (align < p->p_align)
5763 align = p->p_align;
5764 if (align < 1)
5765 align = 1;
5766 p->p_offset = off % align;
5767 }
5768 }
5769 else
5770 {
5771 file_ptr adjust; /* Octets. */
5772
5773 adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
5774 if (!no_contents)
5775 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5776 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5777 }
5778 }
5779
5780 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5781 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5782 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5783 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5784 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5785 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5786 {
5787 asection *sec;
5788 bfd_size_type align;
5789 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5790
5791 sec = *secpp;
5792 this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
5793 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_section_alignment (sec);
5794
5795 if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5796 || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5797 && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
5798 || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
5799 && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
5800 || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
5801 {
5802 bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr; /* Octets. */
5803 bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz; /* Octets. */
5804 bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma * opb; /* Octets. */
5805 bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end; /* Octets. */
5806
5807 if (adjust != 0
5808 && (s_start < p_end
5809 || p_end < p_start))
5810 {
5811 _bfd_error_handler
5812 /* xgettext:c-format */
5813 (_("%pB: section %pA lma %#" PRIx64 " adjusted to %#" PRIx64),
5814 abfd, sec, (uint64_t) s_start / opb,
5815 (uint64_t) p_end / opb);
5816 adjust = 0;
5817 sec->lma = p_end / opb;
5818 }
5819 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5820
5821 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5822 {
5823 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5824 {
5825 off_adjust = 0;
5826 if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
5827 {
5828 /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5829 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5830 zero it. */
5831 adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
5832 if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
5833 return false;
5834 }
5835 }
5836 /* We only adjust sh_offset in SHT_NOBITS sections
5837 as would seem proper for their address when the
5838 section is first in the segment. sh_offset
5839 doesn't really have any significance for
5840 SHT_NOBITS anyway, apart from a notional position
5841 relative to other sections. Historically we
5842 didn't bother with adjusting sh_offset and some
5843 programs depend on it not being adjusted. See
5844 pr12921 and pr25662. */
5845 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS || i == 0)
5846 {
5847 off += adjust;
5848 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
5849 off_adjust += adjust;
5850 }
5851 }
5852 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5853 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5854 }
5855
5856 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5857 {
5858 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5859 everything. */
5860 if (i == 0)
5861 {
5862 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5863 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5864 p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
5865 p->p_memsz = 0;
5866 p->p_align = 1;
5867 }
5868 else
5869 {
5870 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5871 sec->filepos = 0;
5872 sec->size = 0;
5873 sec->flags = 0;
5874 continue;
5875 }
5876 }
5877 else
5878 {
5879 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5880 {
5881 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5882 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5883 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5884 }
5885 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5886 && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
5887 && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
5888 {
5889 /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5890 (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5891 final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5892 would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5893 p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5894 also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5895 p_offset value. */
5896 bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
5897 off, align);
5898 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
5899 }
5900
5901 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5902 {
5903 p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5904 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5905 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5906 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5907 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5908 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5909 }
5910 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5911 {
5912 if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5913 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5914
5915 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5916 normal segments. */
5917 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
5918 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5919 }
5920
5921 if (align > p->p_align
5922 && !m->p_align_valid
5923 && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5924 || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
5925 p->p_align = align;
5926 }
5927
5928 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5929 {
5930 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5931 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
5932 p->p_flags |= PF_X;
5933 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
5934 p->p_flags |= PF_W;
5935 }
5936 }
5937
5938 off -= off_adjust;
5939
5940 /* PR ld/20815 - Check that the program header segment, if
5941 present, will be loaded into memory. */
5942 if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR
5943 && phdr_load_seg == NULL
5944 && !(bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr != NULL
5945 && bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr (abfd, phdrs, alloc)))
5946 {
5947 /* The fix for this error is usually to edit the linker script being
5948 used and set up the program headers manually. Either that or
5949 leave room for the headers at the start of the SECTIONS. */
5950 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: error: PHDR segment not covered"
5951 " by LOAD segment"),
5952 abfd);
5953 if (link_info == NULL)
5954 return false;
5955 /* Arrange for the linker to exit with an error, deleting
5956 the output file unless --noinhibit-exec is given. */
5957 link_info->callbacks->info ("%X");
5958 }
5959
5960 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5961 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5962 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5963 {
5964 bool check_vma = true;
5965
5966 for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
5967 if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
5968 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
5969 ->this_hdr), p) != 0
5970 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
5971 ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
5972 {
5973 /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5974 check_vma = false;
5975 break;
5976 }
5977
5978 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5979 {
5980 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5981 asection *sec;
5982
5983 sec = m->sections[i];
5984 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
5985 if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
5986 && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
5987 {
5988 _bfd_error_handler
5989 /* xgettext:c-format */
5990 (_("%pB: section `%pA' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
5991 abfd, sec, j);
5992 print_segment_map (m);
5993 }
5994 }
5995 }
5996 }
5997
5998 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5999
6000 if (link_info != NULL
6001 && phdr_load_seg != NULL
6002 && phdr_load_seg->includes_filehdr)
6003 {
6004 /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
6005 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
6006 A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
6007
6008 struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
6009 = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
6010 false, false, true);
6011 /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
6012 if (hash != NULL
6013 && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
6014 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6015 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
6016 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
6017 {
6018 asection *s = NULL;
6019 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr = phdrs[phdr_load_seg->idx].p_vaddr / opb;
6020
6021 if (phdr_load_seg->count != 0)
6022 /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
6023 s = phdr_load_seg->sections[0];
6024 else
6025 /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
6026 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
6027 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD && m->count != 0)
6028 {
6029 s = m->sections[0];
6030 break;
6031 }
6032
6033 if (s != NULL)
6034 {
6035 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
6036 hash->root.u.def.section = s;
6037 }
6038 else
6039 {
6040 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
6041 hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6042 }
6043
6044 hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
6045 hash->def_regular = 1;
6046 hash->non_elf = 0;
6047 }
6048 }
6049
6050 return true;
6051 }
6052
6053 /* Determine if a bfd is a debuginfo file. Unfortunately there
6054 is no defined method for detecting such files, so we have to
6055 use heuristics instead. */
6056
6057 bool
6058 is_debuginfo_file (bfd *abfd)
6059 {
6060 if (abfd == NULL || bfd_get_flavour (abfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6061 return false;
6062
6063 Elf_Internal_Shdr **start_headers = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6064 Elf_Internal_Shdr **end_headers = start_headers + elf_numsections (abfd);
6065 Elf_Internal_Shdr **headerp;
6066
6067 for (headerp = start_headers; headerp < end_headers; headerp ++)
6068 {
6069 Elf_Internal_Shdr *header = * headerp;
6070
6071 /* Debuginfo files do not have any allocated SHT_PROGBITS sections.
6072 The only allocated sections are SHT_NOBITS or SHT_NOTES. */
6073 if ((header->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) == SHF_ALLOC
6074 && header->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
6075 && header->sh_type != SHT_NOTE)
6076 return false;
6077 }
6078
6079 return true;
6080 }
6081
6082 /* Assign file positions for the other sections, except for compressed debugging
6083 and other sections assigned in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load(). */
6084
6085 static bool
6086 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
6087 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6088 {
6089 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6090 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
6091 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
6092 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
6093 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
6094 struct elf_segment_map *m;
6095 file_ptr off;
6096 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
6097 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
6098
6099 if (link_info != NULL)
6100 maxpagesize = link_info->maxpagesize;
6101 else
6102 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
6103 i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6104 end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6105 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6106 for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
6107 {
6108 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6109
6110 hdr = *hdrpp;
6111 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6112 && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
6113 || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
6114 && hdr->contents == NULL)))
6115 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
6116 else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
6117 {
6118 if (hdr->sh_size != 0
6119 /* PR 24717 - debuginfo files are known to be not strictly
6120 compliant with the ELF standard. In particular they often
6121 have .note.gnu.property sections that are outside of any
6122 loadable segment. This is not a problem for such files,
6123 so do not warn about them. */
6124 && ! is_debuginfo_file (abfd))
6125 _bfd_error_handler
6126 /* xgettext:c-format */
6127 (_("%pB: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
6128 abfd,
6129 (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
6130 ? "*unknown*"
6131 : hdr->bfd_section->name));
6132 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
6133 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
6134 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
6135 maxpagesize);
6136 else
6137 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
6138 hdr->sh_addralign);
6139 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
6140 false);
6141 }
6142 else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
6143 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
6144 /* We don't know the offset of these sections yet: their size has
6145 not been decided. */
6146 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6147 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
6148 || (bfd_section_is_ctf (hdr->bfd_section)
6149 && abfd->is_linker_output)))
6150 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
6151 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
6152 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
6153 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
6154 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
6155 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
6156 else
6157 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, true);
6158 }
6159 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6160
6161 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
6162 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
6163 phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
6164 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
6165 {
6166 if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6167 {
6168 bfd_vma start, end; /* Bytes. */
6169 bool ok;
6170
6171 if (link_info != NULL)
6172 {
6173 /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
6174 in link_info. Note that there may be padding between
6175 relro_start and the first RELRO section. */
6176 start = link_info->relro_start;
6177 end = link_info->relro_end;
6178 }
6179 else if (m->count != 0)
6180 {
6181 if (!m->p_size_valid)
6182 abort ();
6183 start = m->sections[0]->vma;
6184 end = start + m->p_size / opb;
6185 }
6186 else
6187 {
6188 start = 0;
6189 end = 0;
6190 }
6191
6192 ok = false;
6193 if (start < end)
6194 {
6195 struct elf_segment_map *lm;
6196 const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
6197 unsigned int i;
6198
6199 /* Find a LOAD segment containing a section in the RELRO
6200 segment. */
6201 for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
6202 lm != NULL;
6203 lm = lm->next, lp++)
6204 {
6205 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
6206 && lm->count != 0
6207 && (lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->vma
6208 + (!IS_TBSS (lm->sections[lm->count - 1])
6209 ? lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->size / opb
6210 : 0)) > start
6211 && lm->sections[0]->vma < end)
6212 break;
6213 }
6214
6215 if (lm != NULL)
6216 {
6217 /* Find the section starting the RELRO segment. */
6218 for (i = 0; i < lm->count; i++)
6219 {
6220 asection *s = lm->sections[i];
6221 if (s->vma >= start
6222 && s->vma < end
6223 && s->size != 0)
6224 break;
6225 }
6226
6227 if (i < lm->count)
6228 {
6229 p->p_vaddr = lm->sections[i]->vma * opb;
6230 p->p_paddr = lm->sections[i]->lma * opb;
6231 p->p_offset = lm->sections[i]->filepos;
6232 p->p_memsz = end * opb - p->p_vaddr;
6233 p->p_filesz = p->p_memsz;
6234
6235 /* The RELRO segment typically ends a few bytes
6236 into .got.plt but other layouts are possible.
6237 In cases where the end does not match any
6238 loaded section (for instance is in file
6239 padding), trim p_filesz back to correspond to
6240 the end of loaded section contents. */
6241 if (p->p_filesz > lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr)
6242 p->p_filesz = lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr;
6243
6244 /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are
6245 valid. The gold linker generates RW/4 for
6246 the PT_GNU_RELRO section. It is better for
6247 objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
6248 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate
6249 debug files. */
6250 if (!m->p_align_valid)
6251 p->p_align = 1;
6252 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
6253 p->p_flags = PF_R;
6254 ok = true;
6255 }
6256 }
6257 }
6258 if (link_info != NULL)
6259 BFD_ASSERT (ok);
6260 if (!ok)
6261 memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
6262 }
6263 else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
6264 {
6265 if (m->p_size_valid)
6266 p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
6267 }
6268 else if (m->count != 0)
6269 {
6270 unsigned int i;
6271
6272 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
6273 && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
6274 || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
6275 {
6276 /* A user specified segment layout may include a PHDR
6277 segment that overlaps with a LOAD segment... */
6278 if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR)
6279 {
6280 m->count = 0;
6281 continue;
6282 }
6283
6284 if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
6285 {
6286 /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
6287 _bfd_error_handler
6288 (_("%pB: error: non-load segment %d includes file header "
6289 "and/or program header"),
6290 abfd, (int) (p - phdrs));
6291 return false;
6292 }
6293
6294 p->p_filesz = 0;
6295 p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
6296 for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
6297 {
6298 asection *sect = m->sections[i];
6299 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
6300 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
6301 {
6302 p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
6303 + hdr->sh_size);
6304 /* NB: p_memsz of the loadable PT_NOTE segment
6305 should be the same as p_filesz. */
6306 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE
6307 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
6308 p->p_memsz = p->p_filesz;
6309 break;
6310 }
6311 }
6312 }
6313 }
6314 }
6315
6316 return true;
6317 }
6318
6319 static elf_section_list *
6320 find_section_in_list (unsigned int i, elf_section_list * list)
6321 {
6322 for (;list != NULL; list = list->next)
6323 if (list->ndx == i)
6324 break;
6325 return list;
6326 }
6327
6328 /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
6329 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
6330 VMAs must be known before this is called.
6331
6332 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
6333 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and those that
6334 bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are stored in a normal
6335 bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't consider the former sort
6336 here, unless they form part of the loadable image. Reloc sections not
6337 assigned here (and compressed debugging sections and CTF sections which
6338 nothing else in the file can rely upon) will be handled later by
6339 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
6340
6341 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
6342
6343 static bool
6344 assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
6345 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6346 {
6347 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
6348 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6349 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6350 unsigned int alloc;
6351
6352 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
6353 && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
6354 {
6355 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6356 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6357 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
6358 unsigned int i;
6359 file_ptr off;
6360
6361 /* Start after the ELF header. */
6362 off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
6363
6364 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
6365 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
6366 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
6367 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
6368 {
6369 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6370
6371 hdr = *hdrpp;
6372 if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
6373 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
6374 /* Do not assign offsets for these sections yet: we don't know
6375 their sizes. */
6376 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6377 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
6378 || (bfd_section_is_ctf (hdr->bfd_section)
6379 && abfd->is_linker_output)))
6380 || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
6381 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
6382 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
6383 || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
6384 || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
6385 {
6386 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
6387 }
6388 else
6389 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, true);
6390 }
6391
6392 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6393 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = 0;
6394 }
6395 else
6396 {
6397 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
6398 assignment of sections to segments. */
6399 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6400 return false;
6401
6402 /* And for non-load sections. */
6403 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6404 return false;
6405 }
6406
6407 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_headers) (abfd, link_info))
6408 return false;
6409
6410 /* Write out the program headers. */
6411 alloc = i_ehdrp->e_phnum;
6412 if (alloc != 0)
6413 {
6414 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_ehdrp->e_phoff, SEEK_SET) != 0
6415 || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
6416 return false;
6417 }
6418
6419 return true;
6420 }
6421
6422 bool
6423 _bfd_elf_init_file_header (bfd *abfd,
6424 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6425 {
6426 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
6427 struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
6428 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6429
6430 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6431
6432 shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
6433 if (shstrtab == NULL)
6434 return false;
6435
6436 elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
6437
6438 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
6439 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
6440 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
6441 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
6442
6443 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
6444 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
6445 bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
6446 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
6447
6448 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6449 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
6450 else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
6451 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6452 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
6453 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
6454 else
6455 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
6456
6457 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
6458 {
6459 case bfd_arch_unknown:
6460 i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
6461 break;
6462
6463 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
6464 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
6465 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
6466 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
6467 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
6468 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
6469 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
6470 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
6471 default:
6472 i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
6473 }
6474
6475 i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
6476 i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
6477
6478 /* No program header, for now. */
6479 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6480 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6481 i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
6482
6483 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
6484 i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
6485 i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
6486
6487 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
6488 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", false);
6489 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
6490 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", false);
6491 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
6492 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", false);
6493 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6494 || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6495 || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
6496 return false;
6497
6498 return true;
6499 }
6500
6501 /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=.
6502
6503 FIXME: We used to have code here to sort the PT_LOAD segments into
6504 ascending order, as per the ELF spec. But this breaks some programs,
6505 including the Linux kernel. But really either the spec should be
6506 changed or the programs updated. */
6507
6508 bool
6509 _bfd_elf_modify_headers (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6510 {
6511 if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
6512 {
6513 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (obfd);
6514 unsigned int num_segments = i_ehdrp->e_phnum;
6515 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (obfd);
6516 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = tdata->phdr;
6517 Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
6518
6519 /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
6520 bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
6521 for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
6522 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
6523 p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6524
6525 /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
6526 segments is non-zero. */
6527 if (p_vaddr)
6528 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6529 }
6530 return true;
6531 }
6532
6533 /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
6534 of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
6535
6536 static bool
6537 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
6538 {
6539 file_ptr off;
6540 Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
6541 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
6542 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
6543 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6544
6545 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6546
6547 shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6548 end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6549 for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
6550 {
6551 shdrp = *shdrpp;
6552 if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
6553 {
6554 asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
6555 bool is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
6556 || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
6557 bool is_ctf = sec && bfd_section_is_ctf (sec);
6558 if (is_rel
6559 || is_ctf
6560 || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
6561 {
6562 if (!is_rel && !is_ctf)
6563 {
6564 const char *name = sec->name;
6565 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
6566
6567 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6568 if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
6569 shdrp->contents))
6570 return false;
6571
6572 if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
6573 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
6574 {
6575 /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
6576 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
6577 char *new_name
6578 = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
6579 if (new_name == NULL)
6580 return false;
6581 name = new_name;
6582 }
6583 /* Add section name to section name section. */
6584 if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
6585 abort ();
6586 shdrp->sh_name
6587 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6588 name, false);
6589 d = elf_section_data (sec);
6590
6591 /* Add reloc section name to section name section. */
6592 if (d->rel.hdr
6593 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6594 d->rel.hdr,
6595 name, false))
6596 return false;
6597 if (d->rela.hdr
6598 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6599 d->rela.hdr,
6600 name, true))
6601 return false;
6602
6603 /* Update section size and contents. */
6604 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6605 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6606 shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
6607 }
6608 else if (is_ctf)
6609 {
6610 /* Update section size and contents. */
6611 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6612 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6613 }
6614
6615 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
6616 off,
6617 true);
6618 }
6619 }
6620 }
6621
6622 /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
6623 compressed. */
6624 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6625 shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
6626 shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6627 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, true);
6628
6629 /* Place the section headers. */
6630 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6631 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6632 off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
6633 i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
6634 off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
6635 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6636
6637 return true;
6638 }
6639
6640 bool
6641 _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
6642 {
6643 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6644 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
6645 bool failed;
6646 unsigned int count, num_sec;
6647 struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
6648
6649 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
6650 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
6651 return false;
6652 /* Do not rewrite ELF data when the BFD has been opened for update.
6653 abfd->output_has_begun was set to TRUE on opening, so creation of new
6654 sections, and modification of existing section sizes was restricted.
6655 This means the ELF header, program headers and section headers can't have
6656 changed.
6657 If the contents of any sections has been modified, then those changes have
6658 already been written to the BFD. */
6659 else if (abfd->direction == both_direction)
6660 {
6661 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
6662 return true;
6663 }
6664
6665 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6666
6667 failed = false;
6668 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
6669 if (failed)
6670 return false;
6671
6672 if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
6673 return false;
6674
6675 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
6676 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6677 for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
6678 {
6679 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
6680 = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6681 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
6682 if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
6683 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]))
6684 return false;
6685 if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
6686 {
6687 bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
6688
6689 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6690 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
6691 return false;
6692 }
6693 }
6694
6695 /* Write out the section header names. */
6696 t = elf_tdata (abfd);
6697 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
6698 && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6699 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
6700 return false;
6701
6702 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd))
6703 return false;
6704
6705 if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
6706 return false;
6707
6708 /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
6709 if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
6710 return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
6711
6712 return true;
6713 }
6714
6715 bool
6716 _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
6717 {
6718 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
6719 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
6720 }
6721
6722 /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
6723
6724 unsigned int
6725 _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
6726 {
6727 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6728 unsigned int sec_index;
6729
6730 if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
6731 && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
6732 return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
6733
6734 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
6735 sec_index = SHN_ABS;
6736 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
6737 sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
6738 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
6739 sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
6740 else
6741 sec_index = SHN_BAD;
6742
6743 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6744 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
6745 {
6746 int retval = sec_index;
6747
6748 if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
6749 return retval;
6750 }
6751
6752 if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
6753 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
6754
6755 return sec_index;
6756 }
6757
6758 /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
6759 on error. */
6760
6761 int
6762 _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
6763 {
6764 asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
6765 int idx;
6766 flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
6767
6768 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
6769 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
6770 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
6771 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
6772 input sections rather than the output section. */
6773 if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
6774 && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6775 && asym_ptr->section)
6776 {
6777 asection *sec;
6778 int indx;
6779
6780 sec = asym_ptr->section;
6781 if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
6782 sec = sec->output_section;
6783 if (sec->owner == abfd
6784 && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
6785 && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
6786 asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
6787 }
6788
6789 idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
6790
6791 if (idx == 0)
6792 {
6793 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
6794 which is used in a relocation entry. */
6795 _bfd_error_handler
6796 /* xgettext:c-format */
6797 (_("%pB: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
6798 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
6799 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
6800 return -1;
6801 }
6802
6803 #if DEBUG & 4
6804 {
6805 fprintf (stderr,
6806 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8x\n",
6807 (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, flags);
6808 fflush (stderr);
6809 }
6810 #endif
6811
6812 return idx;
6813 }
6814
6815 /* Rewrite program header information. */
6816
6817 static bool
6818 rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
6819 {
6820 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6821 struct elf_segment_map *map;
6822 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6823 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6824 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6825 asection *section;
6826 unsigned int i;
6827 unsigned int num_segments;
6828 bool phdr_included = false;
6829 bool p_paddr_valid;
6830 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
6831 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
6832 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6833 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (ibfd, NULL);
6834
6835 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6836 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6837
6838 map_first = NULL;
6839 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6840
6841 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6842
6843 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
6844 #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
6845 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
6846 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
6847
6848 #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
6849 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6850 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
6851 ? section->size : 0)
6852
6853 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6854 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
6855 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment, opb) \
6856 (section->vma * (opb) >= segment->p_vaddr \
6857 && (section->vma * (opb) + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6858 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
6859
6860 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6861 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
6862 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base, opb) \
6863 (section->lma * (opb) >= base \
6864 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) / (opb) >= section->lma) \
6865 && (section->lma * (opb) + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6866 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
6867
6868 /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
6869 #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
6870 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
6871 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
6872 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6873 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6874 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6875
6876 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
6877 etc. */
6878 #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
6879 (IS_NOTE (p, s) \
6880 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6881 && s->vma == 0 \
6882 && s->lma == 0)
6883
6884 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6885 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6886 p_memsz set to 0. */
6887 #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6888 (p->p_vaddr == 0 \
6889 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6890 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6891 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6892 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6893 && s->size > 0 \
6894 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6895 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6896 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6897
6898 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6899 A section will be included if:
6900 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6901 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6902 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6903 segment.
6904 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6905 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6906 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6907 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6908 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6909 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6910 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6911 #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed, opb) \
6912 ((((segment->p_paddr \
6913 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr, opb) \
6914 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment, opb)) \
6915 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6916 || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6917 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6918 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6919 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6920 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6921 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6922 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6923 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6924 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6925 || (segment->p_paddr \
6926 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma * (opb) \
6927 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma * (opb)) \
6928 || (strcmp (bfd_section_name (section), ".dynamic") == 0)) \
6929 && (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD || !section->segment_mark))
6930
6931 /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6932 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6933 #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed, opb) \
6934 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed, opb) \
6935 && section->output_section != NULL)
6936
6937 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6938 #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6939 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6940
6941 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6942 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6943 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6944 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6945 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6946 LMA. */
6947 #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6948 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6949 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6950 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6951 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6952
6953 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6954 for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6955 section->segment_mark = false;
6956
6957 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6958 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6959 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6960 don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6961 p_paddr_valid = false;
6962 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6963 i < num_segments;
6964 i++, segment++)
6965 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6966 {
6967 p_paddr_valid = true;
6968 break;
6969 }
6970
6971 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6972 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6973 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6974 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6975 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6976 i < num_segments;
6977 i++, segment++)
6978 {
6979 unsigned int j;
6980 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
6981
6982 if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
6983 for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
6984 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
6985 {
6986 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6987 assignment code will work. */
6988 segment->p_vaddr = section->vma * opb;
6989 break;
6990 }
6991
6992 if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6993 {
6994 /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6995 if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6996 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6997 continue;
6998 }
6999
7000 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
7001 for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
7002 {
7003 bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
7004
7005 if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
7006 || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
7007 continue;
7008
7009 /* Merge the two segments together. */
7010 if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
7011 {
7012 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
7013 SEGMENT. */
7014 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
7015 - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
7016
7017 if (extra_length > 0)
7018 {
7019 segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
7020 segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
7021 }
7022
7023 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
7024
7025 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
7026 i = 0;
7027 segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7028 break;
7029 }
7030 else
7031 {
7032 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
7033 SEGMENT2. */
7034 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
7035 - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
7036
7037 if (extra_length > 0)
7038 {
7039 segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
7040 segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
7041 }
7042
7043 segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
7044 }
7045 }
7046 }
7047
7048 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
7049 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7050 i < num_segments;
7051 i++, segment++)
7052 {
7053 unsigned int section_count;
7054 asection **sections;
7055 asection *output_section;
7056 unsigned int isec;
7057 asection *matching_lma;
7058 asection *suggested_lma;
7059 unsigned int j;
7060 size_t amt;
7061 asection *first_section;
7062
7063 if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
7064 continue;
7065
7066 first_section = NULL;
7067 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
7068 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7069 section != NULL;
7070 section = section->next)
7071 {
7072 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
7073 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
7074 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed, opb))
7075 {
7076 if (first_section == NULL)
7077 first_section = section;
7078 if (section->output_section != NULL)
7079 ++section_count;
7080 }
7081 }
7082
7083 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7084 all of the sections we have selected. */
7085 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
7086 amt += section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7087 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7088 if (map == NULL)
7089 return false;
7090
7091 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
7092 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
7093 map->next = NULL;
7094 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7095 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7096 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7097
7098 if (map->p_type == PT_LOAD
7099 && (ibfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
7100 && maxpagesize > 1
7101 && segment->p_align > 1)
7102 {
7103 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
7104 if (segment->p_align > maxpagesize)
7105 map->p_align = maxpagesize;
7106 map->p_align_valid = 1;
7107 }
7108
7109 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
7110 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
7111 output segment. */
7112 if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
7113 {
7114 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7115 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7116 }
7117
7118 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7119 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7120 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7121 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7122 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7123
7124 if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7125 {
7126 map->includes_phdrs =
7127 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7128 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7129 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7130 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7131
7132 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7133 phdr_included = true;
7134 }
7135
7136 if (section_count == 0)
7137 {
7138 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
7139 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
7140 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
7141 a warning is produced.
7142 There is however the valid use case of embedded systems which
7143 have segments with p_filesz of 0 and a p_memsz > 0 to initialize
7144 flash memory with zeros. No warning is shown for that case. */
7145 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7146 && (segment->p_filesz > 0 || segment->p_memsz == 0))
7147 /* xgettext:c-format */
7148 _bfd_error_handler
7149 (_("%pB: warning: empty loadable segment detected"
7150 " at vaddr=%#" PRIx64 ", is this intentional?"),
7151 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_vaddr);
7152
7153 map->p_vaddr_offset = segment->p_vaddr / opb;
7154 map->count = 0;
7155 *pointer_to_map = map;
7156 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7157
7158 continue;
7159 }
7160
7161 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
7162 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
7163 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
7164 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
7165
7166 1. None of the sections have been moved.
7167 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
7168 input BFD.
7169
7170 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
7171 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
7172 of the first section.
7173
7174 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
7175 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
7176 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
7177 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
7178 have to be created to contain the other sections.
7179
7180 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
7181 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
7182 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
7183 or segments to contain the other sections.
7184
7185 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
7186 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
7187 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
7188
7189 amt = section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7190 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc (amt);
7191 if (sections == NULL)
7192 return false;
7193
7194 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
7195 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
7196 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
7197 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
7198 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
7199 more to do. */
7200 isec = 0;
7201 matching_lma = NULL;
7202 suggested_lma = NULL;
7203
7204 for (section = first_section, j = 0;
7205 section != NULL;
7206 section = section->next)
7207 {
7208 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed, opb))
7209 {
7210 output_section = section->output_section;
7211
7212 sections[j++] = section;
7213
7214 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
7215 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
7216 correct value. Note - some backends require that
7217 p_paddr be left as zero. */
7218 if (!p_paddr_valid
7219 && segment->p_vaddr != 0
7220 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
7221 && isec == 0
7222 && output_section->lma != 0
7223 && (align_power (segment->p_vaddr
7224 + (map->includes_filehdr
7225 ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
7226 + (map->includes_phdrs
7227 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
7228 : 0),
7229 output_section->alignment_power * opb)
7230 == (output_section->vma * opb)))
7231 map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
7232
7233 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
7234 LMA address of the output section. */
7235 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr,
7236 opb)
7237 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
7238 || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
7239 && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment, opb)))
7240 {
7241 if (matching_lma == NULL
7242 || output_section->lma < matching_lma->lma)
7243 matching_lma = output_section;
7244
7245 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
7246 then it does not overlap any other section within that
7247 segment. */
7248 map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
7249 }
7250 else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7251 suggested_lma = output_section;
7252
7253 if (j == section_count)
7254 break;
7255 }
7256 }
7257
7258 BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
7259
7260 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
7261 if necessary. */
7262 if (isec == section_count)
7263 {
7264 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
7265 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
7266 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
7267 program header in the input BFD. */
7268 map->count = section_count;
7269 *pointer_to_map = map;
7270 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7271
7272 if (p_paddr_valid
7273 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7274 {
7275 bfd_vma hdr_size = 0;
7276 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7277 hdr_size = iehdr->e_ehsize;
7278 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7279 hdr_size += iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7280
7281 /* Account for padding before the first section in the
7282 segment. */
7283 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((map->p_paddr + hdr_size) / opb
7284 - matching_lma->lma);
7285 }
7286
7287 free (sections);
7288 continue;
7289 }
7290 else
7291 {
7292 /* Change the current segment's physical address to match
7293 the LMA of the first section that fitted, or if no
7294 section fitted, the first section. */
7295 if (matching_lma == NULL)
7296 matching_lma = suggested_lma;
7297
7298 map->p_paddr = matching_lma->lma * opb;
7299
7300 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
7301 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
7302 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7303 {
7304 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7305
7306 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
7307 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
7308 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
7309 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
7310 offset when we know the correct value. */
7311 phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
7312 phdr_adjust_seg = map;
7313 }
7314
7315 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7316 {
7317 bfd_vma align = (bfd_vma) 1 << matching_lma->alignment_power;
7318 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
7319 /* We've subtracted off the size of headers from the
7320 first section lma, but there may have been some
7321 alignment padding before that section too. Try to
7322 account for that by adjusting the segment lma down to
7323 the same alignment. */
7324 if (segment->p_align != 0 && segment->p_align < align)
7325 align = segment->p_align;
7326 map->p_paddr &= -(align * opb);
7327 }
7328 }
7329
7330 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
7331 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
7332 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
7333 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
7334 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
7335 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
7336 the loop. */
7337 isec = 0;
7338 do
7339 {
7340 map->count = 0;
7341 suggested_lma = NULL;
7342
7343 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
7344 for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
7345 {
7346 section = sections[j];
7347
7348 if (section == NULL)
7349 continue;
7350
7351 output_section = section->output_section;
7352
7353 BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
7354
7355 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr,
7356 opb)
7357 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
7358 {
7359 if (map->count == 0)
7360 {
7361 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
7362 the beginning of the segment, then something is
7363 wrong. */
7364 if (align_power (map->p_paddr
7365 + (map->includes_filehdr
7366 ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
7367 + (map->includes_phdrs
7368 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
7369 : 0),
7370 output_section->alignment_power * opb)
7371 != output_section->lma * opb)
7372 goto sorry;
7373 }
7374 else
7375 {
7376 asection *prev_sec;
7377
7378 prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
7379
7380 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
7381 and the start of this section is more than
7382 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
7383 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
7384 maxpagesize)
7385 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
7386 || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
7387 > output_section->lma))
7388 {
7389 if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7390 suggested_lma = output_section;
7391
7392 continue;
7393 }
7394 }
7395
7396 map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
7397 ++isec;
7398 sections[j] = NULL;
7399 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
7400 section->segment_mark = true;
7401 }
7402 else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7403 suggested_lma = output_section;
7404 }
7405
7406 /* PR 23932. A corrupt input file may contain sections that cannot
7407 be assigned to any segment - because for example they have a
7408 negative size - or segments that do not contain any sections.
7409 But there are also valid reasons why a segment can be empty.
7410 So allow a count of zero. */
7411
7412 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
7413 *pointer_to_map = map;
7414 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7415
7416 if (isec < section_count)
7417 {
7418 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
7419 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
7420 and carry on looping. */
7421 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
7422 amt += section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7423 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7424 if (map == NULL)
7425 {
7426 free (sections);
7427 return false;
7428 }
7429
7430 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
7431 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
7432 not yet been assigned. */
7433 map->next = NULL;
7434 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7435 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7436 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7437 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma->lma * opb;
7438 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7439 map->includes_filehdr = 0;
7440 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7441 }
7442
7443 continue;
7444 sorry:
7445 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry);
7446 free (sections);
7447 return false;
7448 }
7449 while (isec < section_count);
7450
7451 free (sections);
7452 }
7453
7454 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7455
7456 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
7457 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
7458 the offset if necessary. */
7459 if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
7460 {
7461 unsigned int count;
7462
7463 for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7464 count++;
7465
7466 if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
7467 phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
7468 -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7469
7470 for (map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7471 if (map->p_type == PT_PHDR)
7472 {
7473 bfd_vma adjust
7474 = phdr_adjust_seg->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0;
7475 map->p_paddr = phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr + adjust;
7476 break;
7477 }
7478 }
7479
7480 #undef SEGMENT_END
7481 #undef SECTION_SIZE
7482 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
7483 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
7484 #undef IS_NOTE
7485 #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
7486 #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
7487 #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
7488 #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
7489 #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
7490 #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
7491 return true;
7492 }
7493
7494 /* Copy ELF program header information. */
7495
7496 static bool
7497 copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7498 {
7499 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
7500 struct elf_segment_map *map;
7501 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
7502 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
7503 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7504 unsigned int i;
7505 unsigned int num_segments;
7506 bool phdr_included = false;
7507 bool p_paddr_valid;
7508 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (ibfd, NULL);
7509
7510 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
7511
7512 map_first = NULL;
7513 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
7514
7515 /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
7516 map->p_paddr_valid. */
7517 p_paddr_valid = false;
7518 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7519 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7520 i < num_segments;
7521 i++, segment++)
7522 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
7523 {
7524 p_paddr_valid = true;
7525 break;
7526 }
7527
7528 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7529 i < num_segments;
7530 i++, segment++)
7531 {
7532 asection *section;
7533 unsigned int section_count;
7534 size_t amt;
7535 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7536 asection *first_section = NULL;
7537 asection *lowest_section;
7538
7539 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
7540 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7541 section != NULL;
7542 section = section->next)
7543 {
7544 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7545 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7546 {
7547 if (first_section == NULL)
7548 first_section = section;
7549 section_count++;
7550 }
7551 }
7552
7553 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7554 all of the sections we have selected. */
7555 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
7556 amt += section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7557 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7558 if (map == NULL)
7559 return false;
7560
7561 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
7562 input segment. */
7563 map->next = NULL;
7564 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7565 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7566 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7567 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7568 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7569 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
7570 map->p_align_valid = 1;
7571 map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
7572
7573 if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
7574 || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
7575 {
7576 /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
7577 bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
7578 section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
7579 change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
7580 Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
7581 systems. */
7582 map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
7583 map->p_size_valid = 1;
7584 }
7585
7586 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7587 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7588 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7589 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7590
7591 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7592 if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7593 {
7594 map->includes_phdrs =
7595 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7596 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7597 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7598 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7599
7600 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7601 phdr_included = true;
7602 }
7603
7604 lowest_section = NULL;
7605 if (section_count != 0)
7606 {
7607 unsigned int isec = 0;
7608
7609 for (section = first_section;
7610 section != NULL;
7611 section = section->next)
7612 {
7613 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7614 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7615 {
7616 map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
7617 if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7618 {
7619 bfd_vma seg_off;
7620
7621 if (lowest_section == NULL
7622 || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
7623 lowest_section = section;
7624
7625 /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
7626 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
7627 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
7628 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
7629 invalid. */
7630 if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
7631 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
7632 else
7633 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
7634 if (section->lma * opb - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
7635 map->p_paddr_valid = false;
7636 }
7637 if (isec == section_count)
7638 break;
7639 }
7640 }
7641 }
7642
7643 if (section_count == 0)
7644 map->p_vaddr_offset = segment->p_vaddr / opb;
7645 else if (map->p_paddr_valid)
7646 {
7647 /* Account for padding before the first section in the segment. */
7648 bfd_vma hdr_size = 0;
7649 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7650 hdr_size = iehdr->e_ehsize;
7651 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7652 hdr_size += iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7653
7654 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((map->p_paddr + hdr_size) / opb
7655 - (lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0));
7656 }
7657
7658 map->count = section_count;
7659 *pointer_to_map = map;
7660 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7661 }
7662
7663 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7664 return true;
7665 }
7666
7667 /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
7668 information. */
7669
7670 static bool
7671 copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7672 {
7673 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
7674
7675 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7676 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7677 return true;
7678
7679 if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
7680 return true;
7681
7682 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7683 {
7684 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
7685 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
7686 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7687 asection *section, *osec;
7688 unsigned int i, num_segments;
7689 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7690 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7691
7692 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
7693
7694 /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
7695 if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7696 goto rewrite;
7697
7698 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
7699 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7700 section = section->next)
7701 section->segment_mark = false;
7702
7703 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7704 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7705 i < num_segments;
7706 i++, segment++)
7707 {
7708 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
7709 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
7710 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
7711 map in this case. */
7712 if (segment->p_paddr == 0
7713 && segment->p_memsz == 0
7714 && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
7715 goto rewrite;
7716
7717 for (section = ibfd->sections;
7718 section != NULL; section = section->next)
7719 {
7720 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
7721 from the input BFD. */
7722 osec = section->output_section;
7723 if (osec)
7724 osec->segment_mark = true;
7725
7726 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
7727 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7728 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7729 {
7730 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
7731 removed. What else do we need to check? */
7732 if (osec == NULL
7733 || section->flags != osec->flags
7734 || section->lma != osec->lma
7735 || section->vma != osec->vma
7736 || section->size != osec->size
7737 || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
7738 || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
7739 goto rewrite;
7740 }
7741 }
7742 }
7743
7744 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
7745 input BFD. */
7746 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7747 section = section->next)
7748 {
7749 if (!section->segment_mark)
7750 goto rewrite;
7751 else
7752 section->segment_mark = false;
7753 }
7754
7755 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7756 }
7757
7758 rewrite:
7759 maxpagesize = 0;
7760 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7761 {
7762 /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
7763 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
7764 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7765 unsigned int i;
7766 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7767
7768 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7769 i < num_segments;
7770 i++, segment++)
7771 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7772 && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
7773 {
7774 /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
7775 if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
7776 /* xgettext:c-format */
7777 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: warning: segment alignment of %#"
7778 PRIx64 " is too large"),
7779 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_align);
7780 else
7781 maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
7782 }
7783 }
7784 if (maxpagesize == 0)
7785 maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
7786
7787 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd, maxpagesize);
7788 }
7789
7790 /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
7791
7792 bool
7793 _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7794 asection *isec,
7795 bfd *obfd,
7796 asection *osec,
7797 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7798
7799 {
7800 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7801 bool final_link = (link_info != NULL
7802 && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
7803
7804 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7805 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7806 return true;
7807
7808 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
7809
7810 /* If this is a known ABI section, ELF section type and flags may
7811 have been set up when OSEC was created. For normal sections we
7812 allow the user to override the type and flags other than
7813 SHF_MASKOS and SHF_MASKPROC. */
7814 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_PROGBITS
7815 || elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NOTE
7816 || elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NOBITS)
7817 elf_section_type (osec) = SHT_NULL;
7818 /* For objcopy and relocatable link, copy the ELF section type from
7819 the input file if the BFD section flags are the same. (If they
7820 are different the user may be doing something like
7821 "objcopy --set-section-flags .text=alloc,data".) For a final
7822 link allow some flags that the linker clears to differ. */
7823 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
7824 && (osec->flags == isec->flags
7825 || (final_link
7826 && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
7827 & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
7828 elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
7829
7830 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
7831 elf_section_flags (osec) = (elf_section_flags (isec)
7832 & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
7833
7834 /* Copy sh_info from input for mbind section. */
7835 if ((elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind) != 0
7836 && elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
7837 elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr.sh_info
7838 = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.sh_info;
7839
7840 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
7841 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
7842 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
7843 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
7844 if ((link_info == NULL
7845 || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
7846 && (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
7847 || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0))
7848 {
7849 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
7850 elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
7851 elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7852 elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
7853 }
7854
7855 /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
7856 if (!final_link && (ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
7857 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7858 & SHF_COMPRESSED);
7859
7860 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7861
7862 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
7863 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
7864 may be NULL at this point. */
7865 if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
7866 {
7867 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7868 ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
7869 elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
7870 }
7871
7872 osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
7873
7874 return true;
7875 }
7876
7877 /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
7878 field, and sometimes the info field. */
7879
7880 bool
7881 _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7882 asection *isec,
7883 bfd *obfd,
7884 asection *osec)
7885 {
7886 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7887
7888 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7889 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7890 return true;
7891
7892 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7893 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7894
7895 ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
7896
7897 if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
7898 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
7899 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
7900 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
7901 ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
7902
7903 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
7904 NULL);
7905 }
7906
7907 /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
7908 necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
7909 the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
7910 output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
7911 function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
7912 from the linker. */
7913
7914 bool
7915 _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
7916 {
7917 asection *isec;
7918
7919 for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
7920 if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
7921 {
7922 asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7923 asection *s = first;
7924 bfd_size_type removed = 0;
7925
7926 while (s != NULL)
7927 {
7928 /* If this member section is being output but the
7929 SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7930 set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7931 if (s->output_section != discarded
7932 && isec->output_section == discarded)
7933 {
7934 elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
7935 elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
7936 }
7937 else
7938 {
7939 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
7940 if (s->output_section == discarded
7941 && isec->output_section != discarded)
7942 {
7943 /* Conversely, if the member section is not being
7944 output but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust
7945 its size. */
7946 removed += 4;
7947 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
7948 && (elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7949 removed += 4;
7950 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
7951 && (elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7952 removed += 4;
7953 }
7954 else
7955 {
7956 /* Also adjust for zero-sized relocation member
7957 section. */
7958 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
7959 && elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_size == 0)
7960 removed += 4;
7961 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
7962 && elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_size == 0)
7963 removed += 4;
7964 }
7965 }
7966 s = elf_next_in_group (s);
7967 if (s == first)
7968 break;
7969 }
7970 if (removed != 0)
7971 {
7972 if (discarded != NULL)
7973 {
7974 /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7975 adjust the input section size. */
7976 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
7977 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
7978 isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
7979 if (isec->size <= 4)
7980 {
7981 isec->size = 0;
7982 isec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7983 }
7984 }
7985 else
7986 {
7987 /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7988 objcopy. */
7989 isec->output_section->size -= removed;
7990 if (isec->output_section->size <= 4)
7991 {
7992 isec->output_section->size = 0;
7993 isec->output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7994 }
7995 }
7996 }
7997 }
7998
7999 return true;
8000 }
8001
8002 /* Copy private header information. */
8003
8004 bool
8005 _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
8006 {
8007 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
8008 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
8009 return true;
8010
8011 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
8012 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
8013 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
8014 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
8015 already been worked out. */
8016 if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
8017 {
8018 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
8019 return false;
8020 }
8021
8022 return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
8023 }
8024
8025 /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
8026 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
8027 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
8028 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
8029 swap_out_syms function. */
8030
8031 #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
8032 #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
8033 #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
8034 #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
8035 #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
8036
8037 bool
8038 _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
8039 asymbol *isymarg,
8040 bfd *obfd,
8041 asymbol *osymarg)
8042 {
8043 elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
8044
8045 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
8046 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
8047 return true;
8048
8049 isym = elf_symbol_from (isymarg);
8050 osym = elf_symbol_from (osymarg);
8051
8052 if (isym != NULL
8053 && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
8054 && osym != NULL
8055 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
8056 {
8057 unsigned int shndx;
8058
8059 shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
8060 if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
8061 shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
8062 else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
8063 shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
8064 else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
8065 shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
8066 else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
8067 shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
8068 else if (find_section_in_list (shndx, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)))
8069 shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
8070 osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
8071 }
8072
8073 return true;
8074 }
8075
8076 /* Swap out the symbols. */
8077
8078 static bool
8079 swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
8080 struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
8081 int relocatable_p,
8082 struct bfd_link_info *info)
8083 {
8084 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
8085 unsigned int symcount;
8086 asymbol **syms;
8087 struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
8088 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
8089 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
8090 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
8091 struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
8092 bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
8093 bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
8094 unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
8095 unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
8096 unsigned int idx;
8097 unsigned int num_locals;
8098 size_t amt;
8099 bool name_local_sections;
8100
8101 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
8102 return false;
8103
8104 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
8105 stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
8106 if (stt == NULL)
8107 return false;
8108
8109 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8110 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
8111 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8112 symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
8113 symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
8114 symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
8115 symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
8116 symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
8117
8118 symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
8119 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
8120
8121 /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
8122 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount + 1, sizeof (*symstrtab), &amt)
8123 || (symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc (amt)) == NULL)
8124 {
8125 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
8126 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
8127 return false;
8128 }
8129
8130 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount + 1, bed->s->sizeof_sym, &amt)
8131 || (outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt)) == NULL)
8132 {
8133 error_no_mem:
8134 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
8135 error_return:
8136 free (symstrtab);
8137 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
8138 return false;
8139 }
8140 symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
8141 outbound_syms_index = 0;
8142
8143 outbound_shndx = NULL;
8144 outbound_shndx_index = 0;
8145
8146 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
8147 {
8148 symtab_shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
8149 if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
8150 {
8151 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount + 1,
8152 sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx), &amt))
8153 goto error_no_mem;
8154 outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8155 if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
8156 goto error_return;
8157
8158 symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
8159 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
8160 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
8161 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
8162 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
8163 }
8164 /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ? */
8165 }
8166
8167 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
8168 {
8169 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
8170 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
8171 sym.st_name = 0;
8172 sym.st_value = 0;
8173 sym.st_size = 0;
8174 sym.st_info = 0;
8175 sym.st_other = 0;
8176 sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
8177 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
8178 symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
8179 symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
8180 symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
8181 outbound_syms_index++;
8182 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
8183 outbound_shndx_index++;
8184 }
8185
8186 name_local_sections
8187 = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
8188 && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
8189
8190 syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
8191 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
8192 {
8193 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
8194 bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
8195 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
8196 flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
8197 int type;
8198
8199 if (!name_local_sections
8200 && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
8201 {
8202 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
8203 sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
8204 }
8205 else
8206 {
8207 /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
8208 to get the final offset for st_name. */
8209 sym.st_name
8210 = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
8211 false);
8212 if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
8213 goto error_return;
8214 }
8215
8216 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (syms[idx]);
8217
8218 if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
8219 && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
8220 {
8221 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
8222 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
8223 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
8224 sym.st_size = value;
8225 if (type_ptr == NULL
8226 || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
8227 sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
8228 else
8229 sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
8230 sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
8231 (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
8232 }
8233 else
8234 {
8235 asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
8236 unsigned int shndx;
8237
8238 if (sec->output_section)
8239 {
8240 value += sec->output_offset;
8241 sec = sec->output_section;
8242 }
8243
8244 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
8245 if (! relocatable_p)
8246 value += sec->vma;
8247 sym.st_value = value;
8248 sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
8249
8250 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
8251 && type_ptr != NULL
8252 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
8253 {
8254 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
8255 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
8256 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
8257 shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
8258 switch (shndx)
8259 {
8260 case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
8261 shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
8262 break;
8263 case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
8264 shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
8265 break;
8266 case MAP_STRTAB:
8267 shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
8268 break;
8269 case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
8270 shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
8271 break;
8272 case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
8273 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
8274 shndx = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx;
8275 break;
8276 case SHN_COMMON:
8277 case SHN_ABS:
8278 shndx = SHN_ABS;
8279 break;
8280 default:
8281 if (shndx >= SHN_LOPROC && shndx <= SHN_HIOS)
8282 {
8283 if (bed->symbol_section_index)
8284 shndx = bed->symbol_section_index (abfd, type_ptr);
8285 /* Otherwise just leave the index alone. */
8286 }
8287 else
8288 {
8289 if (shndx > SHN_HIOS && shndx < SHN_HIRESERVE)
8290 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: \
8291 Unable to handle section index %x in ELF symbol. Using ABS instead."),
8292 abfd, shndx);
8293 shndx = SHN_ABS;
8294 }
8295 break;
8296 }
8297 }
8298 else
8299 {
8300 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
8301
8302 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
8303 {
8304 asection *sec2;
8305
8306 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
8307 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
8308 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
8309 demand of applications. For example, it
8310 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
8311 section of a symbol to be a section that is
8312 actually in the output file. */
8313 sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
8314 if (sec2 != NULL)
8315 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
8316 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
8317 {
8318 /* xgettext:c-format */
8319 _bfd_error_handler
8320 (_("unable to find equivalent output section"
8321 " for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
8322 syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
8323 sec->name);
8324 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8325 goto error_return;
8326 }
8327 }
8328 }
8329
8330 sym.st_shndx = shndx;
8331 }
8332
8333 if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8334 type = STT_TLS;
8335 else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
8336 type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
8337 else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
8338 type = STT_FUNC;
8339 else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
8340 type = STT_OBJECT;
8341 else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
8342 type = STT_RELC;
8343 else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
8344 type = STT_SRELC;
8345 else
8346 type = STT_NOTYPE;
8347
8348 if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
8349 type = STT_TLS;
8350
8351 /* Processor-specific types. */
8352 if (type_ptr != NULL
8353 && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8354 type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8355 (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
8356
8357 if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
8358 {
8359 if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8360 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8361 else
8362 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
8363 }
8364 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
8365 {
8366 if (type != STT_TLS)
8367 {
8368 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_CONVERT_ELF_COMMON))
8369 type = ((abfd->flags & BFD_USE_ELF_STT_COMMON)
8370 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8371 else
8372 type = ((flags & BSF_ELF_COMMON) != 0
8373 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8374 }
8375 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
8376 }
8377 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
8378 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
8379 ? STB_WEAK
8380 : STB_GLOBAL),
8381 type);
8382 else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
8383 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
8384 else
8385 {
8386 int bind = STB_LOCAL;
8387
8388 if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
8389 bind = STB_LOCAL;
8390 else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
8391 bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
8392 else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
8393 bind = STB_WEAK;
8394 else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8395 bind = STB_GLOBAL;
8396
8397 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
8398 }
8399
8400 if (type_ptr != NULL)
8401 {
8402 sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
8403 sym.st_target_internal
8404 = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
8405 }
8406 else
8407 {
8408 sym.st_other = 0;
8409 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
8410 }
8411
8412 idx++;
8413 symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
8414 symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
8415 symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
8416
8417 outbound_syms_index++;
8418 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
8419 outbound_shndx_index++;
8420 }
8421
8422 /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
8423 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
8424
8425 /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
8426 for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
8427 {
8428 struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
8429 if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
8430 elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
8431 else
8432 elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
8433 elfsym->sym.st_name);
8434 if (info && info->callbacks->ctf_new_symbol)
8435 info->callbacks->ctf_new_symbol (elfsym->dest_index,
8436 &elfsym->sym);
8437
8438 /* Inform the linker of the addition of this symbol. */
8439
8440 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
8441 (outbound_syms
8442 + (elfsym->dest_index
8443 * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
8444 (outbound_shndx
8445 + (elfsym->destshndx_index
8446 * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
8447 }
8448 free (symstrtab);
8449
8450 *sttp = stt;
8451 symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
8452 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
8453 symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
8454 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
8455 symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
8456 symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
8457 symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
8458 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
8459
8460 return true;
8461 }
8462
8463 /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
8464
8465 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
8466 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
8467 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
8468
8469 long
8470 _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8471 {
8472 bfd_size_type symcount;
8473 long symtab_size;
8474 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8475
8476 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8477 if (symcount > LONG_MAX / sizeof (asymbol *))
8478 {
8479 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8480 return -1;
8481 }
8482 symtab_size = symcount * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8483 if (symcount == 0)
8484 symtab_size = sizeof (asymbol *);
8485 else if (!bfd_write_p (abfd))
8486 {
8487 ufile_ptr filesize = bfd_get_file_size (abfd);
8488
8489 if (filesize != 0 && (unsigned long) symtab_size > filesize)
8490 {
8491 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
8492 return -1;
8493 }
8494 }
8495
8496 return symtab_size;
8497 }
8498
8499 long
8500 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8501 {
8502 bfd_size_type symcount;
8503 long symtab_size;
8504 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
8505
8506 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8507 {
8508 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8509 return -1;
8510 }
8511
8512 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8513 if (symcount > LONG_MAX / sizeof (asymbol *))
8514 {
8515 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8516 return -1;
8517 }
8518 symtab_size = symcount * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8519 if (symcount == 0)
8520 symtab_size = sizeof (asymbol *);
8521 else if (!bfd_write_p (abfd))
8522 {
8523 ufile_ptr filesize = bfd_get_file_size (abfd);
8524
8525 if (filesize != 0 && (unsigned long) symtab_size > filesize)
8526 {
8527 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
8528 return -1;
8529 }
8530 }
8531
8532 return symtab_size;
8533 }
8534
8535 long
8536 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr asect)
8537 {
8538 if (asect->reloc_count != 0 && !bfd_write_p (abfd))
8539 {
8540 /* Sanity check reloc section size. */
8541 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d = elf_section_data (asect);
8542 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr = &d->this_hdr;
8543 bfd_size_type ext_rel_size = rel_hdr->sh_size;
8544 ufile_ptr filesize = bfd_get_file_size (abfd);
8545
8546 if (filesize != 0 && ext_rel_size > filesize)
8547 {
8548 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
8549 return -1;
8550 }
8551 }
8552
8553 #if SIZEOF_LONG == SIZEOF_INT
8554 if (asect->reloc_count >= LONG_MAX / sizeof (arelent *))
8555 {
8556 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8557 return -1;
8558 }
8559 #endif
8560 return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
8561 }
8562
8563 /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
8564
8565 long
8566 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8567 sec_ptr section,
8568 arelent **relptr,
8569 asymbol **symbols)
8570 {
8571 arelent *tblptr;
8572 unsigned int i;
8573 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8574
8575 if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, false))
8576 return -1;
8577
8578 tblptr = section->relocation;
8579 for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
8580 *relptr++ = tblptr++;
8581
8582 *relptr = NULL;
8583
8584 return section->reloc_count;
8585 }
8586
8587 long
8588 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
8589 {
8590 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8591 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, false);
8592
8593 if (symcount >= 0)
8594 abfd->symcount = symcount;
8595 return symcount;
8596 }
8597
8598 long
8599 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
8600 asymbol **allocation)
8601 {
8602 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8603 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, true);
8604
8605 if (symcount >= 0)
8606 abfd->dynsymcount = symcount;
8607 return symcount;
8608 }
8609
8610 /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
8611 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
8612 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
8613 dynamic reloc section. */
8614
8615 long
8616 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8617 {
8618 bfd_size_type count, ext_rel_size;
8619 asection *s;
8620
8621 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8622 {
8623 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8624 return -1;
8625 }
8626
8627 count = 1;
8628 ext_rel_size = 0;
8629 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8630 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8631 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8632 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8633 {
8634 ext_rel_size += s->size;
8635 if (ext_rel_size < s->size)
8636 {
8637 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
8638 return -1;
8639 }
8640 count += s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8641 if (count > LONG_MAX / sizeof (arelent *))
8642 {
8643 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8644 return -1;
8645 }
8646 }
8647 if (count > 1 && !bfd_write_p (abfd))
8648 {
8649 /* Sanity check reloc section sizes. */
8650 ufile_ptr filesize = bfd_get_file_size (abfd);
8651 if (filesize != 0 && ext_rel_size > filesize)
8652 {
8653 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
8654 return -1;
8655 }
8656 }
8657 return count * sizeof (arelent *);
8658 }
8659
8660 /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
8661 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
8662 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
8663 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
8664 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
8665 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
8666 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
8667
8668 long
8669 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8670 arelent **storage,
8671 asymbol **syms)
8672 {
8673 bool (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bool);
8674 asection *s;
8675 long ret;
8676
8677 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8678 {
8679 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8680 return -1;
8681 }
8682
8683 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
8684 ret = 0;
8685 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8686 {
8687 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8688 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8689 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8690 {
8691 arelent *p;
8692 long count, i;
8693
8694 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, true))
8695 return -1;
8696 count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8697 p = s->relocation;
8698 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
8699 *storage++ = p++;
8700 ret += count;
8701 }
8702 }
8703
8704 *storage = NULL;
8705
8706 return ret;
8707 }
8708 \f
8709 /* Read in the version information. */
8710
8711 bool
8712 _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bool default_imported_symver)
8713 {
8714 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
8715 unsigned int freeidx = 0;
8716 size_t amt;
8717
8718 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
8719 {
8720 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8721 Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
8722 Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
8723 unsigned int i;
8724 bfd_byte *contents_end;
8725
8726 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
8727
8728 if (hdr->sh_info == 0
8729 || hdr->sh_info > hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
8730 {
8731 error_return_bad_verref:
8732 _bfd_error_handler
8733 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
8734 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8735 error_return_verref:
8736 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
8737 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
8738 goto error_return;
8739 }
8740
8741 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
8742 goto error_return_verref;
8743 contents = _bfd_malloc_and_read (abfd, hdr->sh_size, hdr->sh_size);
8744 if (contents == NULL)
8745 goto error_return_verref;
8746
8747 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed), &amt))
8748 {
8749 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8750 goto error_return_verref;
8751 }
8752 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
8753 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
8754 goto error_return_verref;
8755
8756 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
8757 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
8758 contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
8759 everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
8760 iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
8761 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
8762 {
8763 Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
8764 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
8765 unsigned int j;
8766
8767 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
8768
8769 iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
8770
8771 iverneed->vn_filename =
8772 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8773 iverneed->vn_file);
8774 if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
8775 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8776
8777 if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
8778 iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
8779 else
8780 {
8781 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (iverneed->vn_cnt,
8782 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux), &amt))
8783 {
8784 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8785 goto error_return_verref;
8786 }
8787 iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
8788 bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
8789 if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
8790 goto error_return_verref;
8791 }
8792
8793 if (iverneed->vn_aux
8794 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8795 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8796
8797 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8798 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
8799 ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
8800 for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
8801 {
8802 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
8803
8804 ivernaux->vna_nodename =
8805 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8806 ivernaux->vna_name);
8807 if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
8808 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8809
8810 if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
8811 freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
8812
8813 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
8814 if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
8815 {
8816 iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
8817 break;
8818 }
8819 if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
8820 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
8821
8822 if (ivernaux->vna_next
8823 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
8824 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8825
8826 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8827 ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
8828 }
8829
8830 iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
8831 if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
8832 break;
8833 if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
8834 iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
8835
8836 if (iverneed->vn_next
8837 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8838 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8839
8840 everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
8841 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
8842 }
8843 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
8844
8845 free (contents);
8846 contents = NULL;
8847 }
8848
8849 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
8850 {
8851 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8852 Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
8853 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8854 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
8855 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
8856 unsigned int i;
8857 unsigned int maxidx;
8858 bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
8859
8860 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
8861
8862 if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
8863 {
8864 error_return_bad_verdef:
8865 _bfd_error_handler
8866 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
8867 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8868 error_return_verdef:
8869 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
8870 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
8871 goto error_return;
8872 }
8873
8874 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
8875 goto error_return_verdef;
8876 contents = _bfd_malloc_and_read (abfd, hdr->sh_size, hdr->sh_size);
8877 if (contents == NULL)
8878 goto error_return_verdef;
8879
8880 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
8881 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
8882 contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
8883 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
8884 contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
8885 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
8886
8887 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
8888 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
8889 the maximum. */
8890 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8891 maxidx = 0;
8892 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
8893 {
8894 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8895
8896 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
8897 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8898 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
8899 maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
8900
8901 if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
8902 break;
8903
8904 if (iverdefmem.vd_next
8905 > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8906 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8907
8908 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8909 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
8910 }
8911
8912 if (default_imported_symver)
8913 {
8914 if (freeidx > maxidx)
8915 maxidx = ++freeidx;
8916 else
8917 freeidx = ++maxidx;
8918 }
8919 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef), &amt))
8920 {
8921 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8922 goto error_return_verdef;
8923 }
8924 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8925 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8926 goto error_return_verdef;
8927
8928 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
8929
8930 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8931 iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
8932 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
8933 {
8934 Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
8935 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8936 unsigned int j;
8937
8938 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8939
8940 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
8941 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8942
8943 iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
8944 memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
8945
8946 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8947
8948 if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
8949 iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
8950 else
8951 {
8952 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (iverdef->vd_cnt,
8953 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux), &amt))
8954 {
8955 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8956 goto error_return_verdef;
8957 }
8958 iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8959 bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
8960 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8961 goto error_return_verdef;
8962 }
8963
8964 if (iverdef->vd_aux
8965 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8966 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8967
8968 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8969 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
8970 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8971 for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
8972 {
8973 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
8974
8975 iverdaux->vda_nodename =
8976 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8977 iverdaux->vda_name);
8978 if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
8979 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8980
8981 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
8982 if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
8983 {
8984 iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
8985 break;
8986 }
8987 if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
8988 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
8989
8990 if (iverdaux->vda_next
8991 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
8992 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8993
8994 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8995 ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
8996 }
8997
8998 iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
8999 if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
9000 iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
9001
9002 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
9003 if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
9004 break;
9005 if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
9006 iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
9007
9008 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
9009 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
9010 }
9011
9012 free (contents);
9013 contents = NULL;
9014 }
9015 else if (default_imported_symver)
9016 {
9017 if (freeidx < 3)
9018 freeidx = 3;
9019 else
9020 freeidx++;
9021
9022 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef), &amt))
9023 {
9024 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
9025 goto error_return;
9026 }
9027 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9028 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
9029 goto error_return;
9030
9031 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
9032 }
9033
9034 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
9035 if (default_imported_symver)
9036 {
9037 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
9038 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
9039
9040 iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
9041
9042 iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
9043 iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
9044 iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
9045 iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
9046
9047 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
9048
9049 iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
9050 if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
9051 goto error_return_verdef;
9052 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
9053 iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
9054 bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
9055 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
9056 goto error_return_verdef;
9057
9058 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
9059 iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
9060 }
9061
9062 return true;
9063
9064 error_return:
9065 free (contents);
9066 return false;
9067 }
9068 \f
9069 asymbol *
9070 _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
9071 {
9072 elf_symbol_type *newsym;
9073
9074 newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*newsym));
9075 if (!newsym)
9076 return NULL;
9077 newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
9078 return &newsym->symbol;
9079 }
9080
9081 void
9082 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9083 asymbol *symbol,
9084 symbol_info *ret)
9085 {
9086 bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
9087 }
9088
9089 /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
9090 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
9091 override it. */
9092
9093 bool
9094 _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9095 const char *name)
9096 {
9097 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
9098 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
9099 return true;
9100
9101 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
9102 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
9103 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
9104 return true;
9105
9106 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
9107 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
9108 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
9109 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
9110 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
9111 we treat such symbols as local. */
9112 if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
9113 return true;
9114
9115 /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
9116 forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
9117 These labels have the form:
9118
9119 L0^A.* (fake symbols)
9120
9121 [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
9122
9123 Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
9124 so we only need to match the rest. */
9125 if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
9126 {
9127 bool ret = false;
9128 const char * p;
9129 char c;
9130
9131 for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
9132 {
9133 if (c == 1 || c == 2)
9134 {
9135 if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
9136 /* A fake symbol. */
9137 return true;
9138
9139 /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
9140 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
9141 assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
9142 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
9143 other than some kind of local ? */
9144 ret = true;
9145 }
9146
9147 if (! ISDIGIT (c))
9148 {
9149 ret = false;
9150 break;
9151 }
9152 }
9153 return ret;
9154 }
9155
9156 return false;
9157 }
9158
9159 alent *
9160 _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9161 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9162 {
9163 abort ();
9164 return NULL;
9165 }
9166
9167 bool
9168 _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
9169 enum bfd_architecture arch,
9170 unsigned long machine)
9171 {
9172 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
9173 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
9174 if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
9175 && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
9176 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
9177 return false;
9178
9179 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
9180 }
9181
9182 /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
9183 for error reporting. */
9184
9185 bool
9186 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
9187 asymbol **symbols,
9188 asection *section,
9189 bfd_vma offset,
9190 const char **filename_ptr,
9191 const char **functionname_ptr,
9192 unsigned int *line_ptr,
9193 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
9194 {
9195 bool found;
9196
9197 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
9198 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9199 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
9200 dwarf_debug_sections,
9201 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
9202 return true;
9203
9204 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9205 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr, line_ptr))
9206 {
9207 if (!*functionname_ptr)
9208 _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9209 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
9210 functionname_ptr);
9211 return true;
9212 }
9213
9214 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9215 &found, filename_ptr,
9216 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
9217 &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
9218 return false;
9219 if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
9220 return true;
9221
9222 if (symbols == NULL)
9223 return false;
9224
9225 if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9226 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
9227 return false;
9228
9229 *line_ptr = 0;
9230 return true;
9231 }
9232
9233 /* Find the line for a symbol. */
9234
9235 bool
9236 _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
9237 const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
9238 {
9239 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
9240 filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
9241 dwarf_debug_sections,
9242 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9243 }
9244
9245 /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
9246 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
9247 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
9248 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
9249 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
9250
9251 bool
9252 _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
9253 const char **filename_ptr,
9254 const char **functionname_ptr,
9255 unsigned int *line_ptr)
9256 {
9257 bool found;
9258 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
9259 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
9260 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9261 return found;
9262 }
9263
9264 int
9265 _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
9266 {
9267 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9268 int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
9269
9270 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
9271 {
9272 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
9273
9274 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
9275 {
9276 struct elf_segment_map *m;
9277
9278 phdr_size = 0;
9279 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
9280 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
9281
9282 if (phdr_size == 0)
9283 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
9284 }
9285
9286 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
9287 ret += phdr_size;
9288 }
9289
9290 return ret;
9291 }
9292
9293 bool
9294 _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
9295 sec_ptr section,
9296 const void *location,
9297 file_ptr offset,
9298 bfd_size_type count)
9299 {
9300 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
9301 file_ptr pos;
9302
9303 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
9304 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
9305 return false;
9306
9307 if (!count)
9308 return true;
9309
9310 hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
9311 if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
9312 {
9313 unsigned char *contents;
9314
9315 if (bfd_section_is_ctf (section))
9316 /* Nothing to do with this section: the contents are generated
9317 later. */
9318 return true;
9319
9320 if ((section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0)
9321 {
9322 _bfd_error_handler
9323 (_("%pB:%pA: error: attempting to write into an unallocated compressed section"),
9324 abfd, section);
9325 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
9326 return false;
9327 }
9328
9329 if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size)
9330 {
9331 _bfd_error_handler
9332 (_("%pB:%pA: error: attempting to write over the end of the section"),
9333 abfd, section);
9334
9335 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
9336 return false;
9337 }
9338
9339 contents = hdr->contents;
9340 if (contents == NULL)
9341 {
9342 _bfd_error_handler
9343 (_("%pB:%pA: error: attempting to write section into an empty buffer"),
9344 abfd, section);
9345
9346 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
9347 return false;
9348 }
9349
9350 memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
9351 return true;
9352 }
9353
9354 pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
9355 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
9356 || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
9357 return false;
9358
9359 return true;
9360 }
9361
9362 bool
9363 _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9364 arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9365 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9366 {
9367 abort ();
9368 return false;
9369 }
9370
9371 /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
9372
9373 bool
9374 _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
9375 {
9376 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
9377
9378 if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
9379 {
9380 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
9381 reloc_howto_type *howto;
9382
9383 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
9384 equivalent ELF reloc. */
9385
9386 if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
9387 {
9388 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
9389 {
9390 case 8:
9391 code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
9392 break;
9393 case 12:
9394 code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
9395 break;
9396 case 16:
9397 code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
9398 break;
9399 case 24:
9400 code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
9401 break;
9402 case 32:
9403 code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
9404 break;
9405 case 64:
9406 code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
9407 break;
9408 default:
9409 goto fail;
9410 }
9411
9412 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
9413
9414 if (howto && areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
9415 {
9416 if (howto->pcrel_offset)
9417 areloc->addend += areloc->address;
9418 else
9419 areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
9420 }
9421 }
9422 else
9423 {
9424 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
9425 {
9426 case 8:
9427 code = BFD_RELOC_8;
9428 break;
9429 case 14:
9430 code = BFD_RELOC_14;
9431 break;
9432 case 16:
9433 code = BFD_RELOC_16;
9434 break;
9435 case 26:
9436 code = BFD_RELOC_26;
9437 break;
9438 case 32:
9439 code = BFD_RELOC_32;
9440 break;
9441 case 64:
9442 code = BFD_RELOC_64;
9443 break;
9444 default:
9445 goto fail;
9446 }
9447
9448 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
9449 }
9450
9451 if (howto)
9452 areloc->howto = howto;
9453 else
9454 goto fail;
9455 }
9456
9457 return true;
9458
9459 fail:
9460 /* xgettext:c-format */
9461 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
9462 abfd, areloc->howto->name);
9463 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry);
9464 return false;
9465 }
9466
9467 bool
9468 _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
9469 {
9470 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
9471 if (tdata != NULL
9472 && (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object
9473 || bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
9474 {
9475 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
9476 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
9477 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9478 }
9479
9480 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
9481 }
9482
9483 /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
9484 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
9485 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
9486 this reloc. */
9487
9488 bfd_reloc_status_type
9489 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
9490 (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9491 struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9492 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9493 bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9494 {
9495 return bfd_reloc_ok;
9496 }
9497 \f
9498 /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
9499 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
9500 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
9501 out details about the corefile. */
9502
9503 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
9504 # include <sys/procfs.h>
9505 #endif
9506
9507 /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
9508 PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
9509
9510 static int
9511 elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
9512 {
9513 int pid;
9514
9515 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
9516 if (pid == 0)
9517 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
9518
9519 return pid;
9520 }
9521
9522 /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
9523 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
9524 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
9525 overwrite it. */
9526
9527 static bool
9528 elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
9529 {
9530 asection *sect2;
9531
9532 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
9533 return true;
9534
9535 sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
9536 if (sect2 == NULL)
9537 return false;
9538
9539 sect2->size = sect->size;
9540 sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
9541 sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
9542 return true;
9543 }
9544
9545 /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
9546 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
9547 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
9548 such a section already exists.
9549 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
9550 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
9551 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
9552 bool
9553 _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9554 char *name,
9555 size_t size,
9556 ufile_ptr filepos)
9557 {
9558 char buf[100];
9559 char *threaded_name;
9560 size_t len;
9561 asection *sect;
9562
9563 /* Build the section name. */
9564
9565 sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9566 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9567 threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9568 if (threaded_name == NULL)
9569 return false;
9570 memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
9571
9572 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
9573 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9574 if (sect == NULL)
9575 return false;
9576 sect->size = size;
9577 sect->filepos = filepos;
9578 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9579
9580 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
9581 }
9582
9583 static bool
9584 elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note,
9585 size_t offs)
9586 {
9587 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
9588 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9589
9590 if (sect == NULL)
9591 return false;
9592
9593 sect->size = note->descsz - offs;
9594 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offs;
9595 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9596
9597 return true;
9598 }
9599
9600 /* prstatus_t exists on:
9601 solaris 2.5+
9602 linux 2.[01] + glibc
9603 unixware 4.2
9604 */
9605
9606 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9607
9608 static bool
9609 elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9610 {
9611 size_t size;
9612 int offset;
9613
9614 if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
9615 {
9616 prstatus_t prstat;
9617
9618 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9619 offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
9620 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9621
9622 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9623 has already been set by another thread. */
9624 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9625 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9626 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9627 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9628
9629 /* pr_who exists on:
9630 solaris 2.5+
9631 unixware 4.2
9632 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9633 linux 2.[01]
9634 */
9635 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
9636 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9637 #else
9638 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9639 #endif
9640 }
9641 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9642 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
9643 {
9644 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9645 prstatus32_t prstat;
9646
9647 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9648 offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
9649 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9650
9651 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9652 has already been set by another thread. */
9653 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9654 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9655 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9656 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9657
9658 /* pr_who exists on:
9659 solaris 2.5+
9660 unixware 4.2
9661 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9662 linux 2.[01]
9663 */
9664 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
9665 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9666 #else
9667 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9668 #endif
9669 }
9670 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
9671 else
9672 {
9673 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9674 note size (ie. data object type). */
9675 return true;
9676 }
9677
9678 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9679 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
9680 size, note->descpos + offset);
9681 }
9682 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
9683
9684 /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
9685 static bool
9686 elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9687 char *name,
9688 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9689 {
9690 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
9691 note->descsz, note->descpos);
9692 }
9693
9694 /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
9695 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
9696 data structure apart. */
9697
9698 static bool
9699 elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9700 {
9701 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9702 }
9703
9704 /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
9705 type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
9706 literally. */
9707
9708 static bool
9709 elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9710 {
9711 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
9712 }
9713
9714 /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
9715 with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
9716 contents literally. */
9717
9718 static bool
9719 elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9720 {
9721 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
9722 }
9723
9724 static bool
9725 elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9726 {
9727 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
9728 }
9729
9730 static bool
9731 elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9732 {
9733 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
9734 }
9735
9736 static bool
9737 elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9738 {
9739 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tar", note);
9740 }
9741
9742 static bool
9743 elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9744 {
9745 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-ppr", note);
9746 }
9747
9748 static bool
9749 elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9750 {
9751 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-dscr", note);
9752 }
9753
9754 static bool
9755 elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9756 {
9757 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-ebb", note);
9758 }
9759
9760 static bool
9761 elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9762 {
9763 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-pmu", note);
9764 }
9765
9766 static bool
9767 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9768 {
9769 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr", note);
9770 }
9771
9772 static bool
9773 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9774 {
9775 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr", note);
9776 }
9777
9778 static bool
9779 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9780 {
9781 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx", note);
9782 }
9783
9784 static bool
9785 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9786 {
9787 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx", note);
9788 }
9789
9790 static bool
9791 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9792 {
9793 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr", note);
9794 }
9795
9796 static bool
9797 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9798 {
9799 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar", note);
9800 }
9801
9802 static bool
9803 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9804 {
9805 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr", note);
9806 }
9807
9808 static bool
9809 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9810 {
9811 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr", note);
9812 }
9813
9814 static bool
9815 elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9816 {
9817 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
9818 }
9819
9820 static bool
9821 elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9822 {
9823 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
9824 }
9825
9826 static bool
9827 elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9828 {
9829 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
9830 }
9831
9832 static bool
9833 elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9834 {
9835 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
9836 }
9837
9838 static bool
9839 elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9840 {
9841 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
9842 }
9843
9844 static bool
9845 elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9846 {
9847 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
9848 }
9849
9850 static bool
9851 elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9852 {
9853 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
9854 }
9855
9856 static bool
9857 elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9858 {
9859 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
9860 }
9861
9862 static bool
9863 elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9864 {
9865 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
9866 }
9867
9868 static bool
9869 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9870 {
9871 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
9872 }
9873
9874 static bool
9875 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9876 {
9877 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
9878 }
9879
9880 static bool
9881 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9882 {
9883 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-cb", note);
9884 }
9885
9886 static bool
9887 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9888 {
9889 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-bc", note);
9890 }
9891
9892 static bool
9893 elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9894 {
9895 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
9896 }
9897
9898 static bool
9899 elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9900 {
9901 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
9902 }
9903
9904 static bool
9905 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9906 {
9907 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
9908 }
9909
9910 static bool
9911 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9912 {
9913 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
9914 }
9915
9916 static bool
9917 elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9918 {
9919 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-sve", note);
9920 }
9921
9922 static bool
9923 elfcore_grok_aarch_pauth (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9924 {
9925 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-pauth", note);
9926 }
9927
9928 static bool
9929 elfcore_grok_arc_v2 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9930 {
9931 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arc-v2", note);
9932 }
9933
9934 /* Convert NOTE into a bfd_section called ".reg-riscv-csr". Return TRUE if
9935 successful otherwise, return FALSE. */
9936
9937 static bool
9938 elfcore_grok_riscv_csr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9939 {
9940 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-riscv-csr", note);
9941 }
9942
9943 /* Convert NOTE into a bfd_section called ".gdb-tdesc". Return TRUE if
9944 successful otherwise, return FALSE. */
9945
9946 static bool
9947 elfcore_grok_gdb_tdesc (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9948 {
9949 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".gdb-tdesc", note);
9950 }
9951
9952 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
9953 typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9954 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9955 typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9956 #endif
9957 #endif
9958
9959 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9960 typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9961 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9962 typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9963 #endif
9964 #endif
9965
9966 /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
9967 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
9968 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
9969
9970 char *
9971 _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
9972 {
9973 char *dups;
9974 char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
9975 size_t len;
9976
9977 if (end == NULL)
9978 len = max;
9979 else
9980 len = end - start;
9981
9982 dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
9983 if (dups == NULL)
9984 return NULL;
9985
9986 memcpy (dups, start, len);
9987 dups[len] = '\0';
9988
9989 return dups;
9990 }
9991
9992 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9993 static bool
9994 elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9995 {
9996 if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
9997 {
9998 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
9999
10000 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
10001
10002 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
10003 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
10004 #endif
10005 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
10006 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
10007 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
10008
10009 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10010 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
10011 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
10012 }
10013 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10014 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
10015 {
10016 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
10017 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
10018
10019 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
10020
10021 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
10022 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
10023 #endif
10024 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
10025 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
10026 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
10027
10028 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10029 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
10030 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
10031 }
10032 #endif
10033
10034 else
10035 {
10036 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
10037 note size (ie. data object type). */
10038 return true;
10039 }
10040
10041 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
10042 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
10043 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
10044
10045 {
10046 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
10047 int n = strlen (command);
10048
10049 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
10050 command[n - 1] = '\0';
10051 }
10052
10053 return true;
10054 }
10055 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
10056
10057 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10058 static bool
10059 elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10060 {
10061 if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
10062 #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
10063 || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
10064 #endif
10065 )
10066 {
10067 pstatus_t pstat;
10068
10069 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
10070
10071 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
10072 }
10073 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
10074 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
10075 {
10076 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
10077 pstatus32_t pstat;
10078
10079 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
10080
10081 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
10082 }
10083 #endif
10084 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
10085 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
10086 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
10087
10088 return true;
10089 }
10090 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
10091
10092 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10093 static bool
10094 elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10095 {
10096 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
10097 char buf[100];
10098 char *name;
10099 size_t len;
10100 asection *sect;
10101
10102 if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
10103 #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
10104 && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
10105 #endif
10106 )
10107 return true;
10108
10109 memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
10110
10111 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
10112 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
10113 another thread. */
10114 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
10115 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
10116
10117 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
10118
10119 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
10120 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10121 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10122 if (name == NULL)
10123 return false;
10124 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10125
10126 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10127 if (sect == NULL)
10128 return false;
10129
10130 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10131 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
10132 sect->filepos = note->descpos
10133 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
10134 #endif
10135
10136 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
10137 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
10138 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
10139 #endif
10140
10141 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10142
10143 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
10144 return false;
10145
10146 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
10147
10148 sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
10149 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10150 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10151 if (name == NULL)
10152 return false;
10153 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10154
10155 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10156 if (sect == NULL)
10157 return false;
10158
10159 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10160 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
10161 sect->filepos = note->descpos
10162 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
10163 #endif
10164
10165 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
10166 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
10167 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
10168 #endif
10169
10170 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10171
10172 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
10173 }
10174 #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
10175
10176 /* These constants, and the structure offsets used below, are defined by
10177 Cygwin's core_dump.h */
10178 #define NOTE_INFO_PROCESS 1
10179 #define NOTE_INFO_THREAD 2
10180 #define NOTE_INFO_MODULE 3
10181 #define NOTE_INFO_MODULE64 4
10182
10183 static bool
10184 elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10185 {
10186 char buf[30];
10187 char *name;
10188 size_t len;
10189 unsigned int name_size;
10190 asection *sect;
10191 unsigned int type;
10192 int is_active_thread;
10193 bfd_vma base_addr;
10194
10195 if (note->descsz < 4)
10196 return true;
10197
10198 if (! startswith (note->namedata, "win32"))
10199 return true;
10200
10201 type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
10202
10203 struct
10204 {
10205 const char *type_name;
10206 unsigned long min_size;
10207 } size_check[] =
10208 {
10209 { "NOTE_INFO_PROCESS", 12 },
10210 { "NOTE_INFO_THREAD", 12 },
10211 { "NOTE_INFO_MODULE", 12 },
10212 { "NOTE_INFO_MODULE64", 16 },
10213 };
10214
10215 if (type == 0 || type > (sizeof(size_check)/sizeof(size_check[0])))
10216 return true;
10217
10218 if (note->descsz < size_check[type - 1].min_size)
10219 {
10220 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: warning: win32pstatus %s of size %lu bytes is too small"),
10221 abfd, size_check[type - 1].type_name, note->descsz);
10222 return true;
10223 }
10224
10225 switch (type)
10226 {
10227 case NOTE_INFO_PROCESS:
10228 /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
10229 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
10230 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
10231 break;
10232
10233 case NOTE_INFO_THREAD:
10234 /* Make a ".reg/<tid>" section containing the Win32 API thread CONTEXT
10235 structure. */
10236 /* thread_info.tid */
10237 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4));
10238
10239 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10240 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10241 if (name == NULL)
10242 return false;
10243
10244 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10245
10246 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10247 if (sect == NULL)
10248 return false;
10249
10250 /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
10251 sect->size = note->descsz - 12;
10252 /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
10253 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
10254 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10255
10256 /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
10257 is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
10258
10259 if (is_active_thread)
10260 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
10261 return false;
10262 break;
10263
10264 case NOTE_INFO_MODULE:
10265 case NOTE_INFO_MODULE64:
10266 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
10267 if (type == NOTE_INFO_MODULE)
10268 {
10269 /* module_info.base_address */
10270 base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
10271 sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
10272 /* module_info.module_name_size */
10273 name_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
10274 }
10275 else /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE64 */
10276 {
10277 /* module_info.base_address */
10278 base_addr = bfd_get_64 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
10279 sprintf (buf, ".module/%016lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
10280 /* module_info.module_name_size */
10281 name_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
10282 }
10283
10284 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10285 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10286 if (name == NULL)
10287 return false;
10288
10289 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10290
10291 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10292
10293 if (sect == NULL)
10294 return false;
10295
10296 if (note->descsz < 12 + name_size)
10297 {
10298 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: win32pstatus NOTE_INFO_MODULE of size %lu is too small to contain a name of size %u"),
10299 abfd, note->descsz, name_size);
10300 return true;
10301 }
10302
10303 sect->size = note->descsz;
10304 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10305 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10306 break;
10307
10308 default:
10309 return true;
10310 }
10311
10312 return true;
10313 }
10314
10315 static bool
10316 elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10317 {
10318 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10319
10320 switch (note->type)
10321 {
10322 default:
10323 return true;
10324
10325 case NT_PRSTATUS:
10326 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
10327 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
10328 return true;
10329 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
10330 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
10331 #else
10332 return true;
10333 #endif
10334
10335 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10336 case NT_PSTATUS:
10337 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
10338 #endif
10339
10340 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10341 case NT_LWPSTATUS:
10342 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
10343 #endif
10344
10345 case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
10346 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
10347
10348 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
10349 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
10350
10351 case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
10352 if (note->namesz == 6
10353 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10354 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
10355 else
10356 return true;
10357
10358 case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
10359 if (note->namesz == 6
10360 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10361 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
10362 else
10363 return true;
10364
10365 case NT_PPC_VMX:
10366 if (note->namesz == 6
10367 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10368 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
10369 else
10370 return true;
10371
10372 case NT_PPC_VSX:
10373 if (note->namesz == 6
10374 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10375 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
10376 else
10377 return true;
10378
10379 case NT_PPC_TAR:
10380 if (note->namesz == 6
10381 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10382 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (abfd, note);
10383 else
10384 return true;
10385
10386 case NT_PPC_PPR:
10387 if (note->namesz == 6
10388 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10389 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (abfd, note);
10390 else
10391 return true;
10392
10393 case NT_PPC_DSCR:
10394 if (note->namesz == 6
10395 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10396 return elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (abfd, note);
10397 else
10398 return true;
10399
10400 case NT_PPC_EBB:
10401 if (note->namesz == 6
10402 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10403 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (abfd, note);
10404 else
10405 return true;
10406
10407 case NT_PPC_PMU:
10408 if (note->namesz == 6
10409 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10410 return elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (abfd, note);
10411 else
10412 return true;
10413
10414 case NT_PPC_TM_CGPR:
10415 if (note->namesz == 6
10416 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10417 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd, note);
10418 else
10419 return true;
10420
10421 case NT_PPC_TM_CFPR:
10422 if (note->namesz == 6
10423 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10424 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd, note);
10425 else
10426 return true;
10427
10428 case NT_PPC_TM_CVMX:
10429 if (note->namesz == 6
10430 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10431 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd, note);
10432 else
10433 return true;
10434
10435 case NT_PPC_TM_CVSX:
10436 if (note->namesz == 6
10437 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10438 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd, note);
10439 else
10440 return true;
10441
10442 case NT_PPC_TM_SPR:
10443 if (note->namesz == 6
10444 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10445 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (abfd, note);
10446 else
10447 return true;
10448
10449 case NT_PPC_TM_CTAR:
10450 if (note->namesz == 6
10451 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10452 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd, note);
10453 else
10454 return true;
10455
10456 case NT_PPC_TM_CPPR:
10457 if (note->namesz == 6
10458 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10459 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd, note);
10460 else
10461 return true;
10462
10463 case NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR:
10464 if (note->namesz == 6
10465 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10466 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd, note);
10467 else
10468 return true;
10469
10470 case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
10471 if (note->namesz == 6
10472 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10473 return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
10474 else
10475 return true;
10476
10477 case NT_S390_TIMER:
10478 if (note->namesz == 6
10479 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10480 return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
10481 else
10482 return true;
10483
10484 case NT_S390_TODCMP:
10485 if (note->namesz == 6
10486 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10487 return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
10488 else
10489 return true;
10490
10491 case NT_S390_TODPREG:
10492 if (note->namesz == 6
10493 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10494 return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
10495 else
10496 return true;
10497
10498 case NT_S390_CTRS:
10499 if (note->namesz == 6
10500 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10501 return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
10502 else
10503 return true;
10504
10505 case NT_S390_PREFIX:
10506 if (note->namesz == 6
10507 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10508 return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
10509 else
10510 return true;
10511
10512 case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
10513 if (note->namesz == 6
10514 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10515 return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
10516 else
10517 return true;
10518
10519 case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
10520 if (note->namesz == 6
10521 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10522 return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
10523 else
10524 return true;
10525
10526 case NT_S390_TDB:
10527 if (note->namesz == 6
10528 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10529 return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
10530 else
10531 return true;
10532
10533 case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
10534 if (note->namesz == 6
10535 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10536 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
10537 else
10538 return true;
10539
10540 case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
10541 if (note->namesz == 6
10542 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10543 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
10544 else
10545 return true;
10546
10547 case NT_S390_GS_CB:
10548 if (note->namesz == 6
10549 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10550 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (abfd, note);
10551 else
10552 return true;
10553
10554 case NT_S390_GS_BC:
10555 if (note->namesz == 6
10556 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10557 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (abfd, note);
10558 else
10559 return true;
10560
10561 case NT_ARC_V2:
10562 if (note->namesz == 6
10563 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10564 return elfcore_grok_arc_v2 (abfd, note);
10565 else
10566 return true;
10567
10568 case NT_ARM_VFP:
10569 if (note->namesz == 6
10570 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10571 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10572 else
10573 return true;
10574
10575 case NT_ARM_TLS:
10576 if (note->namesz == 6
10577 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10578 return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
10579 else
10580 return true;
10581
10582 case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
10583 if (note->namesz == 6
10584 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10585 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
10586 else
10587 return true;
10588
10589 case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
10590 if (note->namesz == 6
10591 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10592 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
10593 else
10594 return true;
10595
10596 case NT_ARM_SVE:
10597 if (note->namesz == 6
10598 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10599 return elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (abfd, note);
10600 else
10601 return true;
10602
10603 case NT_ARM_PAC_MASK:
10604 if (note->namesz == 6
10605 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10606 return elfcore_grok_aarch_pauth (abfd, note);
10607 else
10608 return true;
10609
10610 case NT_GDB_TDESC:
10611 if (note->namesz == 4
10612 && strcmp (note->namedata, "GDB") == 0)
10613 return elfcore_grok_gdb_tdesc (abfd, note);
10614 else
10615 return true;
10616
10617 case NT_RISCV_CSR:
10618 if (note->namesz == 4
10619 && strcmp (note->namedata, "GDB") == 0)
10620 return elfcore_grok_riscv_csr (abfd, note);
10621 else
10622 return true;
10623
10624 case NT_PRPSINFO:
10625 case NT_PSINFO:
10626 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
10627 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
10628 return true;
10629 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10630 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
10631 #else
10632 return true;
10633 #endif
10634
10635 case NT_AUXV:
10636 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 0);
10637
10638 case NT_FILE:
10639 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
10640 note);
10641
10642 case NT_SIGINFO:
10643 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
10644 note);
10645
10646 }
10647 }
10648
10649 static bool
10650 elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10651 {
10652 struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
10653
10654 if (note->descsz == 0)
10655 return false;
10656
10657 build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
10658 if (build_id == NULL)
10659 return false;
10660
10661 build_id->size = note->descsz;
10662 memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
10663 abfd->build_id = build_id;
10664
10665 return true;
10666 }
10667
10668 static bool
10669 elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10670 {
10671 switch (note->type)
10672 {
10673 default:
10674 return true;
10675
10676 case NT_GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE_0:
10677 return _bfd_elf_parse_gnu_properties (abfd, note);
10678
10679 case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
10680 return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
10681 }
10682 }
10683
10684 static bool
10685 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10686 {
10687 struct sdt_note *cur =
10688 (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
10689 sizeof (struct sdt_note) + note->descsz);
10690
10691 cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
10692 cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
10693 memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
10694
10695 elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
10696
10697 return true;
10698 }
10699
10700 static bool
10701 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10702 {
10703 switch (note->type)
10704 {
10705 case NT_STAPSDT:
10706 return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
10707
10708 default:
10709 return true;
10710 }
10711 }
10712
10713 static bool
10714 elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10715 {
10716 size_t offset;
10717
10718 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10719 {
10720 case ELFCLASS32:
10721 if (note->descsz < 108)
10722 return false;
10723 break;
10724
10725 case ELFCLASS64:
10726 if (note->descsz < 120)
10727 return false;
10728 break;
10729
10730 default:
10731 return false;
10732 }
10733
10734 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10735 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10736 return false;
10737
10738 offset = 4;
10739
10740 /* Skip over pr_psinfosz. */
10741 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10742 offset += 4;
10743 else
10744 {
10745 offset += 4; /* Padding before pr_psinfosz. */
10746 offset += 8;
10747 }
10748
10749 /* pr_fname is PRFNAMESZ (16) + 1 bytes in size. */
10750 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
10751 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 17);
10752 offset += 17;
10753
10754 /* pr_psargs is PRARGSZ (80) + 1 bytes in size. */
10755 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10756 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 81);
10757 offset += 81;
10758
10759 /* Padding before pr_pid. */
10760 offset += 2;
10761
10762 /* The pr_pid field was added in version "1a". */
10763 if (note->descsz < offset + 4)
10764 return true;
10765
10766 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10767 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10768
10769 return true;
10770 }
10771
10772 static bool
10773 elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10774 {
10775 size_t offset;
10776 size_t size;
10777 size_t min_size;
10778
10779 /* Compute offset of pr_getregsz, skipping over pr_statussz.
10780 Also compute minimum size of this note. */
10781 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10782 {
10783 case ELFCLASS32:
10784 offset = 4 + 4;
10785 min_size = offset + (4 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4;
10786 break;
10787
10788 case ELFCLASS64:
10789 offset = 4 + 4 + 8; /* Includes padding before pr_statussz. */
10790 min_size = offset + (8 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4 + 4;
10791 break;
10792
10793 default:
10794 return false;
10795 }
10796
10797 if (note->descsz < min_size)
10798 return false;
10799
10800 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10801 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10802 return false;
10803
10804 /* Extract size of pr_reg from pr_gregsetsz. */
10805 /* Skip over pr_gregsetsz and pr_fpregsetsz. */
10806 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10807 {
10808 size = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10809 offset += 4 * 2;
10810 }
10811 else
10812 {
10813 size = bfd_h_get_64 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10814 offset += 8 * 2;
10815 }
10816
10817 /* Skip over pr_osreldate. */
10818 offset += 4;
10819
10820 /* Read signal from pr_cursig. */
10821 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
10822 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10823 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10824 offset += 4;
10825
10826 /* Read TID from pr_pid. */
10827 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid
10828 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10829 offset += 4;
10830
10831 /* Padding before pr_reg. */
10832 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
10833 offset += 4;
10834
10835 /* Make sure that there is enough data remaining in the note. */
10836 if ((note->descsz - offset) < size)
10837 return false;
10838
10839 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
10840 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
10841 size, note->descpos + offset);
10842 }
10843
10844 static bool
10845 elfcore_grok_freebsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10846 {
10847 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10848
10849 switch (note->type)
10850 {
10851 case NT_PRSTATUS:
10852 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus)
10853 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus) (abfd, note))
10854 return true;
10855 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (abfd, note);
10856
10857 case NT_FPREGSET:
10858 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
10859
10860 case NT_PRPSINFO:
10861 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (abfd, note);
10862
10863 case NT_FREEBSD_THRMISC:
10864 if (note->namesz == 8)
10865 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".thrmisc", note);
10866 else
10867 return true;
10868
10869 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_PROC:
10870 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.proc",
10871 note);
10872
10873 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_FILES:
10874 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.files",
10875 note);
10876
10877 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_VMMAP:
10878 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.vmmap",
10879 note);
10880
10881 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_AUXV:
10882 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 4);
10883
10884 case NT_X86_XSTATE:
10885 if (note->namesz == 8)
10886 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
10887 else
10888 return true;
10889
10890 case NT_FREEBSD_PTLWPINFO:
10891 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.lwpinfo",
10892 note);
10893
10894 case NT_ARM_VFP:
10895 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10896
10897 default:
10898 return true;
10899 }
10900 }
10901
10902 static bool
10903 elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
10904 {
10905 char *cp;
10906
10907 cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
10908 if (cp != NULL)
10909 {
10910 *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
10911 return true;
10912 }
10913 return false;
10914 }
10915
10916 static bool
10917 elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10918 {
10919 if (note->descsz <= 0x7c + 31)
10920 return false;
10921
10922 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10923 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10924 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10925
10926 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
10927 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10928 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
10929
10930 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10931 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10932 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
10933
10934 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
10935 note);
10936 }
10937
10938 static bool
10939 elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10940 {
10941 int lwp;
10942
10943 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
10944 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
10945
10946 switch (note->type)
10947 {
10948 case NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO:
10949 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
10950 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
10951 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
10952 creates a core file. */
10953 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10954 case NT_NETBSDCORE_AUXV:
10955 /* NetBSD-specific Elf Auxiliary Vector data. */
10956 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 4);
10957 case NT_NETBSDCORE_LWPSTATUS:
10958 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd,
10959 ".note.netbsdcore.lwpstatus",
10960 note);
10961 default:
10962 break;
10963 }
10964
10965 /* As of March 2020 there are no other machine-independent notes
10966 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
10967 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
10968 understand it. */
10969
10970 if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
10971 return true;
10972
10973
10974 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
10975 {
10976 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
10977 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
10978
10979 case bfd_arch_aarch64:
10980 case bfd_arch_alpha:
10981 case bfd_arch_sparc:
10982 switch (note->type)
10983 {
10984 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
10985 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10986
10987 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
10988 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10989
10990 default:
10991 return true;
10992 }
10993
10994 /* On SuperH, PT_GETREGS == mach+3 and PT_GETFPREGS == mach+5.
10995 There's also old PT___GETREGS40 == mach + 1 for old reg
10996 structure which lacks GBR. */
10997
10998 case bfd_arch_sh:
10999 switch (note->type)
11000 {
11001 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
11002 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
11003
11004 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+5:
11005 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
11006
11007 default:
11008 return true;
11009 }
11010
11011 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
11012 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
11013
11014 default:
11015 switch (note->type)
11016 {
11017 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
11018 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
11019
11020 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
11021 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
11022
11023 default:
11024 return true;
11025 }
11026 }
11027 /* NOTREACHED */
11028 }
11029
11030 static bool
11031 elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
11032 {
11033 if (note->descsz <= 0x48 + 31)
11034 return false;
11035
11036 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
11037 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
11038 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
11039
11040 /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
11041 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
11042 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
11043
11044 /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
11045 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
11046 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
11047
11048 return true;
11049 }
11050
11051 static bool
11052 elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
11053 {
11054 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
11055 return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
11056
11057 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
11058 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
11059
11060 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
11061 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
11062
11063 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
11064 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
11065
11066 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
11067 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 0);
11068
11069 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
11070 {
11071 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
11072 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
11073
11074 if (sect == NULL)
11075 return false;
11076 sect->size = note->descsz;
11077 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
11078 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
11079
11080 return true;
11081 }
11082
11083 return true;
11084 }
11085
11086 static bool
11087 elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
11088 {
11089 void *ddata = note->descdata;
11090 char buf[100];
11091 char *name;
11092 asection *sect;
11093 short sig;
11094 unsigned flags;
11095
11096 if (note->descsz < 16)
11097 return false;
11098
11099 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
11100 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
11101
11102 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
11103 *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
11104
11105 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
11106 flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
11107
11108 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
11109 if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
11110 {
11111 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
11112 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
11113 }
11114
11115 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
11116 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
11117 thread just in case. */
11118 if (flags & 0x00000080)
11119 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
11120
11121 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
11122 sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
11123
11124 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
11125 if (name == NULL)
11126 return false;
11127 strcpy (name, buf);
11128
11129 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
11130 if (sect == NULL)
11131 return false;
11132
11133 sect->size = note->descsz;
11134 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
11135 sect->alignment_power = 2;
11136
11137 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
11138 }
11139
11140 static bool
11141 elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
11142 Elf_Internal_Note *note,
11143 long tid,
11144 char *base)
11145 {
11146 char buf[100];
11147 char *name;
11148 asection *sect;
11149
11150 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
11151 sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
11152
11153 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
11154 if (name == NULL)
11155 return false;
11156 strcpy (name, buf);
11157
11158 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
11159 if (sect == NULL)
11160 return false;
11161
11162 sect->size = note->descsz;
11163 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
11164 sect->alignment_power = 2;
11165
11166 /* This is the current thread. */
11167 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
11168 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
11169
11170 return true;
11171 }
11172
11173 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
11174 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
11175 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
11176 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
11177
11178 static bool
11179 elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
11180 {
11181 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
11182 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
11183 function. */
11184 static long tid = 1;
11185
11186 switch (note->type)
11187 {
11188 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
11189 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
11190 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
11191 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
11192 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
11193 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
11194 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
11195 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
11196 default:
11197 return true;
11198 }
11199 }
11200
11201 static bool
11202 elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
11203 {
11204 char *name;
11205 asection *sect;
11206 size_t len;
11207
11208 /* Use note name as section name. */
11209 len = note->namesz;
11210 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
11211 if (name == NULL)
11212 return false;
11213 memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
11214 name[len - 1] = '\0';
11215
11216 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
11217 if (sect == NULL)
11218 return false;
11219
11220 sect->size = note->descsz;
11221 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
11222 sect->alignment_power = 1;
11223
11224 return true;
11225 }
11226
11227 /* Function: elfcore_write_note
11228
11229 Inputs:
11230 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
11231 name of note
11232 type of note
11233 data for note
11234 size of data for note
11235
11236 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
11237 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
11238 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
11239 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
11240
11241 Return:
11242 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
11243
11244 char *
11245 elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
11246 char *buf,
11247 int *bufsiz,
11248 const char *name,
11249 int type,
11250 const void *input,
11251 int size)
11252 {
11253 Elf_External_Note *xnp;
11254 size_t namesz;
11255 size_t newspace;
11256 char *dest;
11257
11258 namesz = 0;
11259 if (name != NULL)
11260 namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
11261
11262 newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
11263
11264 buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
11265 if (buf == NULL)
11266 return buf;
11267 dest = buf + *bufsiz;
11268 *bufsiz += newspace;
11269 xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
11270 H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
11271 H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
11272 H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
11273 dest = xnp->name;
11274 if (name != NULL)
11275 {
11276 memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
11277 dest += namesz;
11278 while (namesz & 3)
11279 {
11280 *dest++ = '\0';
11281 ++namesz;
11282 }
11283 }
11284 memcpy (dest, input, size);
11285 dest += size;
11286 while (size & 3)
11287 {
11288 *dest++ = '\0';
11289 ++size;
11290 }
11291 return buf;
11292 }
11293
11294 /* gcc-8 warns (*) on all the strncpy calls in this function about
11295 possible string truncation. The "truncation" is not a bug. We
11296 have an external representation of structs with fields that are not
11297 necessarily NULL terminated and corresponding internal
11298 representation fields that are one larger so that they can always
11299 be NULL terminated.
11300 gcc versions between 4.2 and 4.6 do not allow pragma control of
11301 diagnostics inside functions, giving a hard error if you try to use
11302 the finer control available with later versions.
11303 gcc prior to 4.2 warns about diagnostic push and pop.
11304 gcc-5, gcc-6 and gcc-7 warn that -Wstringop-truncation is unknown,
11305 unless you also add #pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragma".
11306 (*) Depending on your system header files! */
11307 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
11308 # pragma GCC diagnostic push
11309 # pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wstringop-truncation"
11310 #endif
11311 char *
11312 elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
11313 char *buf,
11314 int *bufsiz,
11315 const char *fname,
11316 const char *psargs)
11317 {
11318 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11319
11320 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
11321 {
11322 char *ret;
11323 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11324 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
11325 if (ret != NULL)
11326 return ret;
11327 }
11328
11329 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
11330 # if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
11331 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
11332 {
11333 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
11334 psinfo32_t data;
11335 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
11336 # else
11337 prpsinfo32_t data;
11338 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
11339 # endif
11340
11341 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
11342 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
11343 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
11344 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11345 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
11346 }
11347 else
11348 # endif
11349 {
11350 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
11351 psinfo_t data;
11352 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
11353 # else
11354 prpsinfo_t data;
11355 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
11356 # endif
11357
11358 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
11359 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
11360 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
11361 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11362 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
11363 }
11364 #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
11365
11366 free (buf);
11367 return NULL;
11368 }
11369 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
11370 # pragma GCC diagnostic pop
11371 #endif
11372
11373 char *
11374 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
11375 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
11376 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
11377 {
11378 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16)
11379 {
11380 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16 data;
11381
11382 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11383 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
11384 &data, sizeof (data));
11385 }
11386 else
11387 {
11388 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32 data;
11389
11390 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11391 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
11392 &data, sizeof (data));
11393 }
11394 }
11395
11396 char *
11397 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
11398 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
11399 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
11400 {
11401 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16)
11402 {
11403 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16 data;
11404
11405 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11406 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11407 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
11408 }
11409 else
11410 {
11411 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32 data;
11412
11413 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11414 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11415 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
11416 }
11417 }
11418
11419 char *
11420 elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
11421 char *buf,
11422 int *bufsiz,
11423 long pid,
11424 int cursig,
11425 const void *gregs)
11426 {
11427 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11428
11429 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
11430 {
11431 char *ret;
11432 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11433 NT_PRSTATUS,
11434 pid, cursig, gregs);
11435 if (ret != NULL)
11436 return ret;
11437 }
11438
11439 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
11440 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
11441 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
11442 {
11443 prstatus32_t prstat;
11444
11445 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
11446 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
11447 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
11448 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
11449 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
11450 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
11451 }
11452 else
11453 #endif
11454 {
11455 prstatus_t prstat;
11456
11457 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
11458 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
11459 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
11460 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
11461 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
11462 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
11463 }
11464 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
11465
11466 free (buf);
11467 return NULL;
11468 }
11469
11470 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
11471 char *
11472 elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
11473 char *buf,
11474 int *bufsiz,
11475 long pid,
11476 int cursig,
11477 const void *gregs)
11478 {
11479 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
11480 const char *note_name = "CORE";
11481
11482 memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
11483 lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
11484 lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
11485 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
11486 memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
11487 #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
11488 #if !defined(gregs)
11489 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
11490 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
11491 #else
11492 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
11493 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
11494 #endif
11495 #endif
11496 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
11497 NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
11498 }
11499 #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
11500
11501 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
11502 char *
11503 elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
11504 char *buf,
11505 int *bufsiz,
11506 long pid,
11507 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11508 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11509 {
11510 const char *note_name = "CORE";
11511 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
11512 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11513
11514 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
11515 {
11516 pstatus32_t pstat;
11517
11518 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
11519 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
11520 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
11521 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
11522 return buf;
11523 }
11524 else
11525 #endif
11526 {
11527 pstatus_t pstat;
11528
11529 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
11530 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
11531 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
11532 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
11533 return buf;
11534 }
11535 }
11536 #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
11537
11538 char *
11539 elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
11540 char *buf,
11541 int *bufsiz,
11542 const void *fpregs,
11543 int size)
11544 {
11545 const char *note_name = "CORE";
11546 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11547 note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
11548 }
11549
11550 char *
11551 elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
11552 char *buf,
11553 int *bufsiz,
11554 const void *xfpregs,
11555 int size)
11556 {
11557 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11558 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11559 note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
11560 }
11561
11562 char *
11563 elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
11564 const void *xfpregs, int size)
11565 {
11566 char *note_name;
11567 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
11568 note_name = "FreeBSD";
11569 else
11570 note_name = "LINUX";
11571 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11572 note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
11573 }
11574
11575 char *
11576 elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
11577 char *buf,
11578 int *bufsiz,
11579 const void *ppc_vmx,
11580 int size)
11581 {
11582 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11583 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11584 note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
11585 }
11586
11587 char *
11588 elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
11589 char *buf,
11590 int *bufsiz,
11591 const void *ppc_vsx,
11592 int size)
11593 {
11594 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11595 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11596 note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
11597 }
11598
11599 char *
11600 elfcore_write_ppc_tar (bfd *abfd,
11601 char *buf,
11602 int *bufsiz,
11603 const void *ppc_tar,
11604 int size)
11605 {
11606 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11607 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11608 note_name, NT_PPC_TAR, ppc_tar, size);
11609 }
11610
11611 char *
11612 elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (bfd *abfd,
11613 char *buf,
11614 int *bufsiz,
11615 const void *ppc_ppr,
11616 int size)
11617 {
11618 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11619 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11620 note_name, NT_PPC_PPR, ppc_ppr, size);
11621 }
11622
11623 char *
11624 elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (bfd *abfd,
11625 char *buf,
11626 int *bufsiz,
11627 const void *ppc_dscr,
11628 int size)
11629 {
11630 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11631 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11632 note_name, NT_PPC_DSCR, ppc_dscr, size);
11633 }
11634
11635 char *
11636 elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (bfd *abfd,
11637 char *buf,
11638 int *bufsiz,
11639 const void *ppc_ebb,
11640 int size)
11641 {
11642 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11643 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11644 note_name, NT_PPC_EBB, ppc_ebb, size);
11645 }
11646
11647 char *
11648 elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (bfd *abfd,
11649 char *buf,
11650 int *bufsiz,
11651 const void *ppc_pmu,
11652 int size)
11653 {
11654 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11655 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11656 note_name, NT_PPC_PMU, ppc_pmu, size);
11657 }
11658
11659 char *
11660 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd *abfd,
11661 char *buf,
11662 int *bufsiz,
11663 const void *ppc_tm_cgpr,
11664 int size)
11665 {
11666 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11667 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11668 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CGPR, ppc_tm_cgpr, size);
11669 }
11670
11671 char *
11672 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd *abfd,
11673 char *buf,
11674 int *bufsiz,
11675 const void *ppc_tm_cfpr,
11676 int size)
11677 {
11678 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11679 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11680 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CFPR, ppc_tm_cfpr, size);
11681 }
11682
11683 char *
11684 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd *abfd,
11685 char *buf,
11686 int *bufsiz,
11687 const void *ppc_tm_cvmx,
11688 int size)
11689 {
11690 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11691 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11692 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CVMX, ppc_tm_cvmx, size);
11693 }
11694
11695 char *
11696 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd *abfd,
11697 char *buf,
11698 int *bufsiz,
11699 const void *ppc_tm_cvsx,
11700 int size)
11701 {
11702 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11703 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11704 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CVSX, ppc_tm_cvsx, size);
11705 }
11706
11707 char *
11708 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (bfd *abfd,
11709 char *buf,
11710 int *bufsiz,
11711 const void *ppc_tm_spr,
11712 int size)
11713 {
11714 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11715 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11716 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_SPR, ppc_tm_spr, size);
11717 }
11718
11719 char *
11720 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd *abfd,
11721 char *buf,
11722 int *bufsiz,
11723 const void *ppc_tm_ctar,
11724 int size)
11725 {
11726 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11727 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11728 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CTAR, ppc_tm_ctar, size);
11729 }
11730
11731 char *
11732 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd *abfd,
11733 char *buf,
11734 int *bufsiz,
11735 const void *ppc_tm_cppr,
11736 int size)
11737 {
11738 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11739 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11740 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CPPR, ppc_tm_cppr, size);
11741 }
11742
11743 char *
11744 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd *abfd,
11745 char *buf,
11746 int *bufsiz,
11747 const void *ppc_tm_cdscr,
11748 int size)
11749 {
11750 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11751 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11752 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR, ppc_tm_cdscr, size);
11753 }
11754
11755 static char *
11756 elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
11757 char *buf,
11758 int *bufsiz,
11759 const void *s390_high_gprs,
11760 int size)
11761 {
11762 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11763 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11764 note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
11765 s390_high_gprs, size);
11766 }
11767
11768 char *
11769 elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
11770 char *buf,
11771 int *bufsiz,
11772 const void *s390_timer,
11773 int size)
11774 {
11775 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11776 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11777 note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
11778 }
11779
11780 char *
11781 elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
11782 char *buf,
11783 int *bufsiz,
11784 const void *s390_todcmp,
11785 int size)
11786 {
11787 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11788 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11789 note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
11790 }
11791
11792 char *
11793 elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
11794 char *buf,
11795 int *bufsiz,
11796 const void *s390_todpreg,
11797 int size)
11798 {
11799 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11800 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11801 note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
11802 }
11803
11804 char *
11805 elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
11806 char *buf,
11807 int *bufsiz,
11808 const void *s390_ctrs,
11809 int size)
11810 {
11811 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11812 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11813 note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
11814 }
11815
11816 char *
11817 elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
11818 char *buf,
11819 int *bufsiz,
11820 const void *s390_prefix,
11821 int size)
11822 {
11823 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11824 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11825 note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
11826 }
11827
11828 char *
11829 elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
11830 char *buf,
11831 int *bufsiz,
11832 const void *s390_last_break,
11833 int size)
11834 {
11835 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11836 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11837 note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
11838 s390_last_break, size);
11839 }
11840
11841 char *
11842 elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
11843 char *buf,
11844 int *bufsiz,
11845 const void *s390_system_call,
11846 int size)
11847 {
11848 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11849 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11850 note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
11851 s390_system_call, size);
11852 }
11853
11854 char *
11855 elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
11856 char *buf,
11857 int *bufsiz,
11858 const void *s390_tdb,
11859 int size)
11860 {
11861 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11862 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11863 note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
11864 }
11865
11866 char *
11867 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
11868 char *buf,
11869 int *bufsiz,
11870 const void *s390_vxrs_low,
11871 int size)
11872 {
11873 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11874 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11875 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
11876 }
11877
11878 char *
11879 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
11880 char *buf,
11881 int *bufsiz,
11882 const void *s390_vxrs_high,
11883 int size)
11884 {
11885 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11886 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11887 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
11888 s390_vxrs_high, size);
11889 }
11890
11891 char *
11892 elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd,
11893 char *buf,
11894 int *bufsiz,
11895 const void *s390_gs_cb,
11896 int size)
11897 {
11898 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11899 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11900 note_name, NT_S390_GS_CB,
11901 s390_gs_cb, size);
11902 }
11903
11904 char *
11905 elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd,
11906 char *buf,
11907 int *bufsiz,
11908 const void *s390_gs_bc,
11909 int size)
11910 {
11911 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11912 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11913 note_name, NT_S390_GS_BC,
11914 s390_gs_bc, size);
11915 }
11916
11917 char *
11918 elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
11919 char *buf,
11920 int *bufsiz,
11921 const void *arm_vfp,
11922 int size)
11923 {
11924 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11925 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11926 note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
11927 }
11928
11929 char *
11930 elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
11931 char *buf,
11932 int *bufsiz,
11933 const void *aarch_tls,
11934 int size)
11935 {
11936 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11937 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11938 note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
11939 }
11940
11941 char *
11942 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
11943 char *buf,
11944 int *bufsiz,
11945 const void *aarch_hw_break,
11946 int size)
11947 {
11948 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11949 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11950 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
11951 }
11952
11953 char *
11954 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
11955 char *buf,
11956 int *bufsiz,
11957 const void *aarch_hw_watch,
11958 int size)
11959 {
11960 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11961 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11962 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
11963 }
11964
11965 char *
11966 elfcore_write_aarch_sve (bfd *abfd,
11967 char *buf,
11968 int *bufsiz,
11969 const void *aarch_sve,
11970 int size)
11971 {
11972 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11973 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11974 note_name, NT_ARM_SVE, aarch_sve, size);
11975 }
11976
11977 char *
11978 elfcore_write_aarch_pauth (bfd *abfd,
11979 char *buf,
11980 int *bufsiz,
11981 const void *aarch_pauth,
11982 int size)
11983 {
11984 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11985 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11986 note_name, NT_ARM_PAC_MASK, aarch_pauth, size);
11987 }
11988
11989 char *
11990 elfcore_write_arc_v2 (bfd *abfd,
11991 char *buf,
11992 int *bufsiz,
11993 const void *arc_v2,
11994 int size)
11995 {
11996 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11997 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11998 note_name, NT_ARC_V2, arc_v2, size);
11999 }
12000
12001 /* Write the buffer of csr values in CSRS (length SIZE) into the note
12002 buffer BUF and update *BUFSIZ. ABFD is the bfd the note is being
12003 written into. Return a pointer to the new start of the note buffer, to
12004 replace BUF which may no longer be valid. */
12005
12006 char *
12007 elfcore_write_riscv_csr (bfd *abfd,
12008 char *buf,
12009 int *bufsiz,
12010 const void *csrs,
12011 int size)
12012 {
12013 const char *note_name = "GDB";
12014 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
12015 note_name, NT_RISCV_CSR, csrs, size);
12016 }
12017
12018 /* Write the target description (a string) pointed to by TDESC, length
12019 SIZE, into the note buffer BUF, and update *BUFSIZ. ABFD is the bfd the
12020 note is being written into. Return a pointer to the new start of the
12021 note buffer, to replace BUF which may no longer be valid. */
12022
12023 char *
12024 elfcore_write_gdb_tdesc (bfd *abfd,
12025 char *buf,
12026 int *bufsiz,
12027 const void *tdesc,
12028 int size)
12029 {
12030 const char *note_name = "GDB";
12031 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
12032 note_name, NT_GDB_TDESC, tdesc, size);
12033 }
12034
12035 char *
12036 elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
12037 char *buf,
12038 int *bufsiz,
12039 const char *section,
12040 const void *data,
12041 int size)
12042 {
12043 if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
12044 return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12045 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
12046 return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12047 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
12048 return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12049 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
12050 return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12051 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
12052 return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12053 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tar") == 0)
12054 return elfcore_write_ppc_tar (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12055 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-ppr") == 0)
12056 return elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12057 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-dscr") == 0)
12058 return elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12059 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-ebb") == 0)
12060 return elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12061 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-pmu") == 0)
12062 return elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12063 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr") == 0)
12064 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12065 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr") == 0)
12066 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12067 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx") == 0)
12068 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12069 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx") == 0)
12070 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12071 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr") == 0)
12072 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12073 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar") == 0)
12074 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12075 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr") == 0)
12076 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12077 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr") == 0)
12078 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12079 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
12080 return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12081 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
12082 return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12083 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
12084 return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12085 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
12086 return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12087 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
12088 return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12089 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
12090 return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12091 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
12092 return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12093 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
12094 return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12095 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
12096 return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12097 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
12098 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12099 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
12100 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12101 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-cb") == 0)
12102 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12103 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-bc") == 0)
12104 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12105 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
12106 return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12107 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
12108 return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12109 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
12110 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12111 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
12112 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12113 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-sve") == 0)
12114 return elfcore_write_aarch_sve (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12115 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-pauth") == 0)
12116 return elfcore_write_aarch_pauth (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12117 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arc-v2") == 0)
12118 return elfcore_write_arc_v2 (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12119 if (strcmp (section, ".gdb-tdesc") == 0)
12120 return elfcore_write_gdb_tdesc (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12121 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-riscv-csr") == 0)
12122 return elfcore_write_riscv_csr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
12123 return NULL;
12124 }
12125
12126 char *
12127 elfcore_write_file_note (bfd *obfd, char *note_data, int *note_size,
12128 const void *buf, int bufsiz)
12129 {
12130 return elfcore_write_note (obfd, note_data, note_size,
12131 "CORE", NT_FILE, buf, bufsiz);
12132 }
12133
12134 static bool
12135 elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset,
12136 size_t align)
12137 {
12138 char *p;
12139
12140 /* NB: CORE PT_NOTE segments may have p_align values of 0 or 1.
12141 gABI specifies that PT_NOTE alignment should be aligned to 4
12142 bytes for 32-bit objects and to 8 bytes for 64-bit objects. If
12143 align is less than 4, we use 4 byte alignment. */
12144 if (align < 4)
12145 align = 4;
12146 if (align != 4 && align != 8)
12147 return false;
12148
12149 p = buf;
12150 while (p < buf + size)
12151 {
12152 Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
12153 Elf_Internal_Note in;
12154
12155 if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
12156 return false;
12157
12158 in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
12159
12160 in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
12161 in.namedata = xnp->name;
12162 if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
12163 return false;
12164
12165 in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
12166 in.descdata = p + ELF_NOTE_DESC_OFFSET (in.namesz, align);
12167 in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
12168 if (in.descsz != 0
12169 && (in.descdata >= buf + size
12170 || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
12171 return false;
12172
12173 switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
12174 {
12175 default:
12176 return true;
12177
12178 case bfd_core:
12179 {
12180 #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
12181 struct
12182 {
12183 const char * string;
12184 size_t len;
12185 bool (*func) (bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
12186 }
12187 grokers[] =
12188 {
12189 GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
12190 GROKER_ELEMENT ("FreeBSD", elfcore_grok_freebsd_note),
12191 GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
12192 GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
12193 GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
12194 GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note),
12195 GROKER_ELEMENT ("GNU", elfobj_grok_gnu_note)
12196 };
12197 #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
12198 int i;
12199
12200 for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
12201 {
12202 if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
12203 && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
12204 grokers[i].len) == 0)
12205 {
12206 if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
12207 return false;
12208 break;
12209 }
12210 }
12211 break;
12212 }
12213
12214 case bfd_object:
12215 if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
12216 {
12217 if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
12218 return false;
12219 }
12220 else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
12221 && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
12222 {
12223 if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
12224 return false;
12225 }
12226 break;
12227 }
12228
12229 p += ELF_NOTE_NEXT_OFFSET (in.namesz, in.descsz, align);
12230 }
12231
12232 return true;
12233 }
12234
12235 bool
12236 elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size,
12237 size_t align)
12238 {
12239 char *buf;
12240
12241 if (size == 0 || (size + 1) == 0)
12242 return true;
12243
12244 if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
12245 return false;
12246
12247 buf = (char *) _bfd_malloc_and_read (abfd, size + 1, size);
12248 if (buf == NULL)
12249 return false;
12250
12251 /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
12252 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
12253 buf[size] = 0;
12254
12255 if (!elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset, align))
12256 {
12257 free (buf);
12258 return false;
12259 }
12260
12261 free (buf);
12262 return true;
12263 }
12264 \f
12265 /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
12266
12267 /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
12268 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
12269 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
12270
12271 long
12272 bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
12273 {
12274 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
12275 {
12276 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
12277 return -1;
12278 }
12279
12280 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
12281 }
12282
12283 /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
12284 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
12285 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
12286 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
12287
12288 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
12289 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
12290
12291 int
12292 bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
12293 {
12294 int num_phdrs;
12295
12296 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
12297 {
12298 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
12299 return -1;
12300 }
12301
12302 num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
12303 if (num_phdrs != 0)
12304 memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
12305 num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
12306
12307 return num_phdrs;
12308 }
12309
12310 enum elf_reloc_type_class
12311 _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12312 const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12313 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12314 {
12315 return reloc_class_normal;
12316 }
12317
12318 /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
12319 relocation against a local symbol. */
12320
12321 bfd_vma
12322 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
12323 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
12324 asection **psec,
12325 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
12326 {
12327 asection *sec = *psec;
12328 bfd_vma relocation;
12329
12330 relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
12331 + sec->output_offset
12332 + sym->st_value);
12333 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
12334 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
12335 && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
12336 {
12337 rel->r_addend =
12338 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
12339 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
12340 sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
12341 if (sec != *psec)
12342 {
12343 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
12344 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
12345 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
12346 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
12347 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
12348 if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
12349 sec->kept_section = *psec;
12350 sec = *psec;
12351 }
12352 rel->r_addend -= relocation;
12353 rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
12354 }
12355 return relocation;
12356 }
12357
12358 bfd_vma
12359 _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
12360 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
12361 asection **psec,
12362 bfd_vma addend)
12363 {
12364 asection *sec = *psec;
12365
12366 if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
12367 return sym->st_value + addend;
12368
12369 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
12370 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
12371 sym->st_value + addend);
12372 }
12373
12374 /* Adjust an address within a section. Given OFFSET within SEC, return
12375 the new offset within the section, based upon changes made to the
12376 section. Returns -1 if the offset is now invalid.
12377 The offset (in abnd out) is in target sized bytes, however big a
12378 byte may be. */
12379
12380 bfd_vma
12381 _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
12382 struct bfd_link_info *info,
12383 asection *sec,
12384 bfd_vma offset)
12385 {
12386 switch (sec->sec_info_type)
12387 {
12388 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
12389 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
12390 offset);
12391 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
12392 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
12393
12394 default:
12395 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
12396 {
12397 /* Reverse the offset. */
12398 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12399 bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
12400
12401 /* address_size and sec->size are in octets. Convert
12402 to bytes before subtracting the original offset. */
12403 offset = ((sec->size - address_size)
12404 / bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) - offset);
12405 }
12406 return offset;
12407 }
12408 }
12409 \f
12410 /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
12411 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
12412 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
12413 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
12414 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
12415 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
12416
12417 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
12418 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
12419 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
12420 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
12421 the remote memory. */
12422
12423 bfd *
12424 bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
12425 (bfd *templ,
12426 bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
12427 bfd_size_type size,
12428 bfd_vma *loadbasep,
12429 int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
12430 {
12431 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
12432 (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
12433 }
12434 \f
12435 long
12436 _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
12437 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12438 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12439 long dynsymcount,
12440 asymbol **dynsyms,
12441 asymbol **ret)
12442 {
12443 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12444 asection *relplt;
12445 asymbol *s;
12446 const char *relplt_name;
12447 bool (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bool);
12448 arelent *p;
12449 long count, i, n;
12450 size_t size;
12451 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
12452 char *names;
12453 asection *plt;
12454
12455 *ret = NULL;
12456
12457 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
12458 return 0;
12459
12460 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
12461 return 0;
12462
12463 if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
12464 return 0;
12465
12466 relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
12467 if (relplt_name == NULL)
12468 relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
12469 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
12470 if (relplt == NULL)
12471 return 0;
12472
12473 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
12474 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
12475 || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
12476 return 0;
12477
12478 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
12479 if (plt == NULL)
12480 return 0;
12481
12482 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
12483 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, true))
12484 return -1;
12485
12486 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
12487 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
12488 p = relplt->relocation;
12489 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
12490 {
12491 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
12492 if (p->addend != 0)
12493 {
12494 #ifdef BFD64
12495 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
12496 #else
12497 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
12498 #endif
12499 }
12500 }
12501
12502 s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
12503 if (s == NULL)
12504 return -1;
12505
12506 names = (char *) (s + count);
12507 p = relplt->relocation;
12508 n = 0;
12509 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
12510 {
12511 size_t len;
12512 bfd_vma addr;
12513
12514 addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
12515 if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
12516 continue;
12517
12518 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
12519 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
12520 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
12521 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
12522 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
12523 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
12524 s->section = plt;
12525 s->value = addr - plt->vma;
12526 s->name = names;
12527 s->udata.p = NULL;
12528 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
12529 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
12530 names += len;
12531 if (p->addend != 0)
12532 {
12533 char buf[30], *a;
12534
12535 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
12536 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
12537 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
12538 for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
12539 ;
12540 len = strlen (a);
12541 memcpy (names, a, len);
12542 names += len;
12543 }
12544 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
12545 names += sizeof ("@plt");
12546 ++s, ++n;
12547 }
12548
12549 return n;
12550 }
12551
12552 /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.
12553 ??? This repeats *COM* id of zero. sec->id is supposed to be unique,
12554 but current usage would allow all of _bfd_std_section to be zero. */
12555 static const asymbol lcomm_sym
12556 = GLOBAL_SYM_INIT ("LARGE_COMMON", &_bfd_elf_large_com_section);
12557 asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
12558 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section, &lcomm_sym,
12559 "LARGE_COMMON", 0, SEC_IS_COMMON);
12560
12561 bool
12562 _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
12563 {
12564 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
12565
12566 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
12567
12568 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE)
12569 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
12570
12571 /* Set the osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains
12572 SHF_GNU_MBIND or SHF_GNU_RETAIN sections or symbols of STT_GNU_IFUNC type
12573 or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
12574 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi != 0)
12575 {
12576 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE)
12577 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
12578 else if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] != ELFOSABI_GNU
12579 && i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] != ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
12580 {
12581 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind)
12582 _bfd_error_handler (_("GNU_MBIND section is supported only by GNU "
12583 "and FreeBSD targets"));
12584 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_ifunc)
12585 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol type STT_GNU_IFUNC is supported "
12586 "only by GNU and FreeBSD targets"));
12587 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_unique)
12588 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol binding STB_GNU_UNIQUE is supported "
12589 "only by GNU and FreeBSD targets"));
12590 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_retain)
12591 _bfd_error_handler (_("GNU_RETAIN section is supported "
12592 "only by GNU and FreeBSD targets"));
12593 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry);
12594 return false;
12595 }
12596 }
12597 return true;
12598 }
12599
12600
12601 /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
12602 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
12603 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
12604
12605 bool
12606 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
12607 {
12608 return (type == STT_FUNC
12609 || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
12610 }
12611
12612 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
12613 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
12614 otherwise return zero. */
12615
12616 bfd_size_type
12617 _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
12618 bfd_vma *code_off)
12619 {
12620 bfd_size_type size;
12621
12622 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
12623 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
12624 || sym->section != sec)
12625 return 0;
12626
12627 *code_off = sym->value;
12628 size = 0;
12629 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
12630 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
12631 if (size == 0)
12632 size = 1;
12633 return size;
12634 }
12635
12636 /* Set to non-zero to enable some debug messages. */
12637 #define DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS 0
12638
12639 /* An internal-to-the-bfd-library only section type
12640 used to indicate a cached secondary reloc section. */
12641 #define SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC (SHT_LOOS + SHT_RELA)
12642
12643 /* Create a BFD section to hold a secondary reloc section. */
12644
12645 bool
12646 _bfd_elf_init_secondary_reloc_section (bfd * abfd,
12647 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
12648 const char * name,
12649 unsigned int shindex)
12650 {
12651 /* We only support RELA secondary relocs. */
12652 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA)
12653 return false;
12654
12655 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12656 fprintf (stderr, "secondary reloc section %s encountered\n", name);
12657 #endif
12658 hdr->sh_type = SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC;
12659 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
12660 }
12661
12662 /* Read in any secondary relocs associated with SEC. */
12663
12664 bool
12665 _bfd_elf_slurp_secondary_reloc_section (bfd * abfd,
12666 asection * sec,
12667 asymbol ** symbols,
12668 bool dynamic)
12669 {
12670 const struct elf_backend_data * const ebd = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12671 asection * relsec;
12672 bool result = true;
12673 bfd_vma (*r_sym) (bfd_vma);
12674
12675 #if BFD_DEFAULT_TARGET_SIZE > 32
12676 if (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) != 32)
12677 r_sym = elf64_r_sym;
12678 else
12679 #endif
12680 r_sym = elf32_r_sym;
12681
12682 /* Discover if there are any secondary reloc sections
12683 associated with SEC. */
12684 for (relsec = abfd->sections; relsec != NULL; relsec = relsec->next)
12685 {
12686 Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr = & elf_section_data (relsec)->this_hdr;
12687
12688 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC
12689 && hdr->sh_info == (unsigned) elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx
12690 && (hdr->sh_entsize == ebd->s->sizeof_rel
12691 || hdr->sh_entsize == ebd->s->sizeof_rela))
12692 {
12693 bfd_byte * native_relocs;
12694 bfd_byte * native_reloc;
12695 arelent * internal_relocs;
12696 arelent * internal_reloc;
12697 unsigned int i;
12698 unsigned int entsize;
12699 unsigned int symcount;
12700 unsigned int reloc_count;
12701 size_t amt;
12702
12703 if (ebd->elf_info_to_howto == NULL)
12704 return false;
12705
12706 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12707 fprintf (stderr, "read secondary relocs for %s from %s\n",
12708 sec->name, relsec->name);
12709 #endif
12710 entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
12711
12712 native_relocs = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
12713 if (native_relocs == NULL)
12714 {
12715 result = false;
12716 continue;
12717 }
12718
12719 reloc_count = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr);
12720 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (reloc_count, sizeof (arelent), & amt))
12721 {
12722 free (native_relocs);
12723 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
12724 result = false;
12725 continue;
12726 }
12727
12728 internal_relocs = (arelent *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
12729 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
12730 {
12731 free (native_relocs);
12732 result = false;
12733 continue;
12734 }
12735
12736 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
12737 || (bfd_bread (native_relocs, hdr->sh_size, abfd)
12738 != hdr->sh_size))
12739 {
12740 free (native_relocs);
12741 /* The internal_relocs will be freed when
12742 the memory for the bfd is released. */
12743 result = false;
12744 continue;
12745 }
12746
12747 if (dynamic)
12748 symcount = bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd);
12749 else
12750 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
12751
12752 for (i = 0, internal_reloc = internal_relocs,
12753 native_reloc = native_relocs;
12754 i < reloc_count;
12755 i++, internal_reloc++, native_reloc += entsize)
12756 {
12757 bool res;
12758 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
12759
12760 if (entsize == ebd->s->sizeof_rel)
12761 ebd->s->swap_reloc_in (abfd, native_reloc, & rela);
12762 else /* entsize == ebd->s->sizeof_rela */
12763 ebd->s->swap_reloca_in (abfd, native_reloc, & rela);
12764
12765 /* The address of an ELF reloc is section relative for an object
12766 file, and absolute for an executable file or shared library.
12767 The address of a normal BFD reloc is always section relative,
12768 and the address of a dynamic reloc is absolute.. */
12769 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0)
12770 internal_reloc->address = rela.r_offset;
12771 else
12772 internal_reloc->address = rela.r_offset - sec->vma;
12773
12774 if (r_sym (rela.r_info) == STN_UNDEF)
12775 {
12776 /* FIXME: This and the error case below mean that we
12777 have a symbol on relocs that is not elf_symbol_type. */
12778 internal_reloc->sym_ptr_ptr =
12779 bfd_abs_section_ptr->symbol_ptr_ptr;
12780 }
12781 else if (r_sym (rela.r_info) > symcount)
12782 {
12783 _bfd_error_handler
12784 /* xgettext:c-format */
12785 (_("%pB(%pA): relocation %d has invalid symbol index %ld"),
12786 abfd, sec, i, (long) r_sym (rela.r_info));
12787 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12788 internal_reloc->sym_ptr_ptr =
12789 bfd_abs_section_ptr->symbol_ptr_ptr;
12790 result = false;
12791 }
12792 else
12793 {
12794 asymbol **ps;
12795
12796 ps = symbols + r_sym (rela.r_info) - 1;
12797 internal_reloc->sym_ptr_ptr = ps;
12798 /* Make sure that this symbol is not removed by strip. */
12799 (*ps)->flags |= BSF_KEEP;
12800 }
12801
12802 internal_reloc->addend = rela.r_addend;
12803
12804 res = ebd->elf_info_to_howto (abfd, internal_reloc, & rela);
12805 if (! res || internal_reloc->howto == NULL)
12806 {
12807 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12808 fprintf (stderr, "there is no howto associated with reloc %lx\n",
12809 rela.r_info);
12810 #endif
12811 result = false;
12812 }
12813 }
12814
12815 free (native_relocs);
12816 /* Store the internal relocs. */
12817 elf_section_data (relsec)->sec_info = internal_relocs;
12818 }
12819 }
12820
12821 return result;
12822 }
12823
12824 /* Set the ELF section header fields of an output secondary reloc section. */
12825
12826 bool
12827 _bfd_elf_copy_special_section_fields (const bfd * ibfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12828 bfd * obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12829 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * isection,
12830 Elf_Internal_Shdr * osection)
12831 {
12832 asection * isec;
12833 asection * osec;
12834 struct bfd_elf_section_data * esd;
12835
12836 if (isection == NULL)
12837 return false;
12838
12839 if (isection->sh_type != SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC)
12840 return true;
12841
12842 isec = isection->bfd_section;
12843 if (isec == NULL)
12844 return false;
12845
12846 osec = osection->bfd_section;
12847 if (osec == NULL)
12848 return false;
12849
12850 esd = elf_section_data (osec);
12851 BFD_ASSERT (esd->sec_info == NULL);
12852 esd->sec_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
12853 osection->sh_type = SHT_RELA;
12854 osection->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (obfd);
12855 if (osection->sh_link == 0)
12856 {
12857 /* There is no symbol table - we are hosed... */
12858 _bfd_error_handler
12859 /* xgettext:c-format */
12860 (_("%pB(%pA): link section cannot be set because the output file does not have a symbol table"),
12861 obfd, osec);
12862 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12863 return false;
12864 }
12865
12866 /* Find the output section that corresponds to the isection's sh_info link. */
12867 if (isection->sh_info == 0
12868 || isection->sh_info >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
12869 {
12870 _bfd_error_handler
12871 /* xgettext:c-format */
12872 (_("%pB(%pA): info section index is invalid"),
12873 obfd, osec);
12874 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12875 return false;
12876 }
12877
12878 isection = elf_elfsections (ibfd)[isection->sh_info];
12879
12880 if (isection == NULL
12881 || isection->bfd_section == NULL
12882 || isection->bfd_section->output_section == NULL)
12883 {
12884 _bfd_error_handler
12885 /* xgettext:c-format */
12886 (_("%pB(%pA): info section index cannot be set because the section is not in the output"),
12887 obfd, osec);
12888 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12889 return false;
12890 }
12891
12892 esd = elf_section_data (isection->bfd_section->output_section);
12893 BFD_ASSERT (esd != NULL);
12894 osection->sh_info = esd->this_idx;
12895 esd->has_secondary_relocs = true;
12896 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12897 fprintf (stderr, "update header of %s, sh_link = %u, sh_info = %u\n",
12898 osec->name, osection->sh_link, osection->sh_info);
12899 fprintf (stderr, "mark section %s as having secondary relocs\n",
12900 bfd_section_name (isection->bfd_section->output_section));
12901 #endif
12902
12903 return true;
12904 }
12905
12906 /* Write out a secondary reloc section.
12907
12908 FIXME: Currently this function can result in a serious performance penalty
12909 for files with secondary relocs and lots of sections. The proper way to
12910 fix this is for _bfd_elf_copy_special_section_fields() to chain secondary
12911 relocs together and then to have this function just walk that chain. */
12912
12913 bool
12914 _bfd_elf_write_secondary_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
12915 {
12916 const struct elf_backend_data * const ebd = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12917 bfd_vma addr_offset;
12918 asection * relsec;
12919 bfd_vma (*r_info) (bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
12920 bool result = true;
12921
12922 if (sec == NULL)
12923 return false;
12924
12925 #if BFD_DEFAULT_TARGET_SIZE > 32
12926 if (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) != 32)
12927 r_info = elf64_r_info;
12928 else
12929 #endif
12930 r_info = elf32_r_info;
12931
12932 /* The address of an ELF reloc is section relative for an object
12933 file, and absolute for an executable file or shared library.
12934 The address of a BFD reloc is always section relative. */
12935 addr_offset = 0;
12936 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) != 0)
12937 addr_offset = sec->vma;
12938
12939 /* Discover if there are any secondary reloc sections
12940 associated with SEC. */
12941 for (relsec = abfd->sections; relsec != NULL; relsec = relsec->next)
12942 {
12943 const struct bfd_elf_section_data * const esd = elf_section_data (relsec);
12944 Elf_Internal_Shdr * const hdr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) & esd->this_hdr;
12945
12946 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA
12947 && hdr->sh_info == (unsigned) elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx)
12948 {
12949 asymbol * last_sym;
12950 int last_sym_idx;
12951 unsigned int reloc_count;
12952 unsigned int idx;
12953 unsigned int entsize;
12954 arelent * src_irel;
12955 bfd_byte * dst_rela;
12956
12957 if (hdr->contents != NULL)
12958 {
12959 _bfd_error_handler
12960 /* xgettext:c-format */
12961 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section processed twice"),
12962 abfd, relsec);
12963 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12964 result = false;
12965 continue;
12966 }
12967
12968 entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
12969 if (entsize == 0)
12970 {
12971 _bfd_error_handler
12972 /* xgettext:c-format */
12973 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section has zero sized entries"),
12974 abfd, relsec);
12975 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12976 result = false;
12977 continue;
12978 }
12979 else if (entsize != ebd->s->sizeof_rel
12980 && entsize != ebd->s->sizeof_rela)
12981 {
12982 _bfd_error_handler
12983 /* xgettext:c-format */
12984 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section has non-standard sized entries"),
12985 abfd, relsec);
12986 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12987 result = false;
12988 continue;
12989 }
12990
12991 reloc_count = hdr->sh_size / entsize;
12992 if (reloc_count <= 0)
12993 {
12994 _bfd_error_handler
12995 /* xgettext:c-format */
12996 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section is empty!"),
12997 abfd, relsec);
12998 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12999 result = false;
13000 continue;
13001 }
13002
13003 hdr->contents = bfd_alloc (abfd, hdr->sh_size);
13004 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
13005 continue;
13006
13007 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
13008 fprintf (stderr, "write %u secondary relocs for %s from %s\n",
13009 reloc_count, sec->name, relsec->name);
13010 #endif
13011 last_sym = NULL;
13012 last_sym_idx = 0;
13013 dst_rela = hdr->contents;
13014 src_irel = (arelent *) esd->sec_info;
13015 if (src_irel == NULL)
13016 {
13017 _bfd_error_handler
13018 /* xgettext:c-format */
13019 (_("%pB(%pA): error: internal relocs missing for secondary reloc section"),
13020 abfd, relsec);
13021 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13022 result = false;
13023 continue;
13024 }
13025
13026 for (idx = 0; idx < reloc_count; idx++, dst_rela += entsize)
13027 {
13028 Elf_Internal_Rela src_rela;
13029 arelent *ptr;
13030 asymbol *sym;
13031 int n;
13032
13033 ptr = src_irel + idx;
13034 if (ptr == NULL)
13035 {
13036 _bfd_error_handler
13037 /* xgettext:c-format */
13038 (_("%pB(%pA): error: reloc table entry %u is empty"),
13039 abfd, relsec, idx);
13040 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13041 result = false;
13042 break;
13043 }
13044
13045 if (ptr->sym_ptr_ptr == NULL)
13046 {
13047 /* FIXME: Is this an error ? */
13048 n = 0;
13049 }
13050 else
13051 {
13052 sym = *ptr->sym_ptr_ptr;
13053
13054 if (sym == last_sym)
13055 n = last_sym_idx;
13056 else
13057 {
13058 n = _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (abfd, & sym);
13059 if (n < 0)
13060 {
13061 _bfd_error_handler
13062 /* xgettext:c-format */
13063 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc %u references a missing symbol"),
13064 abfd, relsec, idx);
13065 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13066 result = false;
13067 n = 0;
13068 }
13069
13070 last_sym = sym;
13071 last_sym_idx = n;
13072 }
13073
13074 if (sym->the_bfd != NULL
13075 && sym->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec
13076 && ! _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (abfd, ptr))
13077 {
13078 _bfd_error_handler
13079 /* xgettext:c-format */
13080 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc %u references a deleted symbol"),
13081 abfd, relsec, idx);
13082 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13083 result = false;
13084 n = 0;
13085 }
13086 }
13087
13088 src_rela.r_offset = ptr->address + addr_offset;
13089 if (ptr->howto == NULL)
13090 {
13091 _bfd_error_handler
13092 /* xgettext:c-format */
13093 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc %u is of an unknown type"),
13094 abfd, relsec, idx);
13095 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
13096 result = false;
13097 src_rela.r_info = r_info (0, 0);
13098 }
13099 else
13100 src_rela.r_info = r_info (n, ptr->howto->type);
13101 src_rela.r_addend = ptr->addend;
13102
13103 if (entsize == ebd->s->sizeof_rel)
13104 ebd->s->swap_reloc_out (abfd, &src_rela, dst_rela);
13105 else /* entsize == ebd->s->sizeof_rela */
13106 ebd->s->swap_reloca_out (abfd, &src_rela, dst_rela);
13107 }
13108 }
13109 }
13110
13111 return result;
13112 }
This page took 0.336825 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.